Add gdb_report_register_access_error command
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{imx_gpio}
599 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
600
601 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
602 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
603 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
604
605 @end itemize
606
607 @node About Jim-Tcl
608 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
609 @cindex Jim-Tcl
610 @cindex tcl
611
612 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
613 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
614 command interpreter.
615
616 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
617 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
618 much of anything about Tcl.
619 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
620
621 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
622 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
623 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
624 OpenOCD mailing list.
625
626 @itemize @bullet
627 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
628 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
629 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
630 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
631 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
632 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
633
634 @item @b{Missing Features}
635 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
636 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
637 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
638 enabled in OpenOCD.
639
640 @item @b{Scripts}
641 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
642 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
643 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
644
645 @item @b{Commands}
646 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
647 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
648 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
649 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
650
651 @item @b{Historical Note}
652 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
653 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
654 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
655 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
656
657 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
658 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
659 @end itemize
660
661 @node Running
662 @chapter Running
663 @cindex command line options
664 @cindex logfile
665 @cindex directory search
666
667 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
668 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
669 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
670 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
671 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
672 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
673 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
674
675 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
676 tell it how each debug session should work.
677 The @option{--help} option shows:
678 @verbatim
679 bash$ openocd --help
680
681 --help | -h display this help
682 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
683 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
684 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
685 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
686 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
687 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
688 --command | -c run <command>
689 @end verbatim
690
691 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
692 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
693 To specify one or more different
694 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
695
696 @example
697 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
698 @end example
699
700 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
701 @enumerate
702 @item the current directory,
703 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
704 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
705 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
706 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
707 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
708 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
709 @end enumerate
710 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
711
712 @quotation Note
713 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
714 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
715 @end quotation
716
717 @section Simple setup, no customization
718
719 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
720 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
721 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
722 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
723 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
724
725 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
726 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
727 the server with some variation of one of the following:
728
729 @example
730 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
731 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
732 @end example
733
734 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
735 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
736 If all goes well you'll see output something like
737
738 @example
739 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
740 For bug reports, read
741 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
742 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
743 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
744 @end example
745
746 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
747 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
748 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
749
750 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
751
752 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
753 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
754 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
755 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
756 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
757 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
758 ensure that this always succeeds.
759 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
760 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
761 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
762 and then shut down without acting as a server.
763
764 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
765 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
766 those channels.
767
768 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
769 the @option{-d} option.
770
771 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
772 @option{-c} command line switch.
773
774 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
775 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
776 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
777 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
778 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
779 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
780 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
781
782 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
783 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
784
785 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
786 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
787 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
788 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
789
790 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
791 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
792
793 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
794 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
795 and start the OpenOCD server.
796 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
797 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
798 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
799 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
800
801 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
802
803 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
804 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
805 and a USB cable on the other.
806 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
807 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
808
809 @enumerate
810 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
811 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
812 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
813 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
814 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
815 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
816 debugging host.
817
818 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
819 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
820 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
821 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
822 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
823
824 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
825 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
826 with 1.2 Volt boards.
827
828 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
829 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
830 ways to connect the cable.
831 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
832 Be sure it's firmly connected.
833
834 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
835 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
836 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
837 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
838 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
839 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
840 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
841 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
842
843 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
844 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
845 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
846 but are tedious to set up.
847 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
848 adapter signals to the right board pins.
849
850 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
851 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
852 you are using to run OpenOCD.
853 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
854
855 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
856 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
857 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
858 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
859
860 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
861 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
862 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
863
864 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
865 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
866 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
867 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
868
869 @end enumerate
870
871 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
872 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
873 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
874
875 @section Project Directory
876
877 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
878
879 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
880 single directory for your work with a given board.
881 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
882 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
883 files accessed through semihosting,
884 and for code you upload to the target board.
885 It is also the natural place to write files,
886 such as log files and data you download from the board.
887
888 @section Configuration Basics
889
890 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
891 a variety of ways you can mix them.
892 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
893
894 @itemize
895 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
896 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
897 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
898 @end itemize
899
900 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
901 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
902 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
903
904 @example
905 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
906
907 # GDB can also flash my flash!
908 gdb_memory_map enable
909 gdb_flash_program enable
910
911 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
912 @end example
913
914 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
915
916 @example
917 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
918 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
919 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
920 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
921 @end example
922
923 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
924 each supporting a different development task.
925 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
926 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
927
928 @quotation Important
929 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
930 problems with how it treats variables.
931 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
932 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
933 that can be tested in a later script.
934 @end quotation
935
936 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
937 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
938 to simplify your work.
939
940 @section User Config Files
941 @cindex config file, user
942 @cindex user config file
943 @cindex config file, overview
944
945 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
946 in one place.
947 One of the following will match your situation best:
948
949 @itemize
950 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
951 provided by someone else.
952 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
953 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
954 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
955 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
956 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
957 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
958
959 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
960 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
961
962 @enumerate
963 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
964 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
965 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
966 @end enumerate
967
968 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
969 The first is an interface config file.
970 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
971 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
972 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
973 meet your deadline:
974
975 @example
976 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
977 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
978 @end example
979
980 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
981 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
982 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
983 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
984
985 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
986 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
987 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
988 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
989 target and board
990 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
991 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
992
993 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
994 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
995 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
996 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
997
998 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
999 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1000 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1001 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1002 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1003
1004 @quotation Note
1005 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1006 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1007 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1008 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1009 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1010 @end quotation
1011
1012 @item
1013 You may may need to write some C code.
1014 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1015 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1016 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1017 a new chip architecture.
1018 @end itemize
1019
1020 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1021 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1022 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1023
1024 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1025 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1026 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1027 @itemize
1028
1029 @item
1030 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1031 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1032 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1033 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1034
1035 @item
1036 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1037 @cindex vector_catch
1038 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1039 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1040 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1041 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1042 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1043 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1044
1045 @item
1046 You might need to override some defaults.
1047 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1048 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1049
1050 @item
1051 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1052 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1053 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1054 @end itemize
1055
1056 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1057
1058 A few project-specific utility
1059 routines may well speed up your work.
1060 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1061
1062 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1063 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1064 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1065 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1066 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1067 may help:
1068
1069 @example
1070 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1071 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1072 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1073 # Leave the CPU halted.
1074 reset init
1075
1076 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1077 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1078
1079 # Start running.
1080 resume 0x20000000
1081 @}
1082 @end example
1083
1084 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1085 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1086 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1087 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1088 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1089
1090 @example
1091 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1092 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1093 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1094 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1095 reset init
1096
1097 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1098 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1099 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1100 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1101 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1102 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1103 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1104
1105 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1106 reset run
1107 @}
1108 @end example
1109
1110 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1111 from NAND.
1112 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1113 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1114 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1115
1116 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1117 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1118
1119 @section Target Software Changes
1120
1121 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1122 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1123 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1124 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1125 handling issues like:
1126
1127 @itemize @bullet
1128
1129 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1130 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1131 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1132 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1133 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1134 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1135 your debug sessions.
1136
1137 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1138 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1139 That might however be your only option.
1140
1141 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1142 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1143 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1144 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1145 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1146 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1147 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1148 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1149 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1150 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1151 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1152 instead of the whole thing.
1153 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1154 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1155
1156 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1157 @cindex ARM semihosting
1158 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1159 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1160 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1161 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1162 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1163 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1164 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1165 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1166 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1167 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1168 NAND or SPI flash.
1169
1170 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1171 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1172 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1173 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1174 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1175
1176 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1177 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1178 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1179 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1180 registers which can be used to change various features including
1181 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1182 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1183 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1184 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1185 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1186
1187 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1188 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1189 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1190 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1191 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1192
1193 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1194 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1195 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1196 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1197 early code execution can be debugged
1198 or firmware can be replaced.
1199
1200 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1201 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1202 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1203 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1204 operations like writing to memory.)
1205
1206 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1207 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1208 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1209 various kinds of message.
1210 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1211
1212 @end itemize
1213
1214 @section Target Hardware Setup
1215
1216 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1217 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1218 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1219 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1220 working with.}
1221
1222 Common issues include:
1223
1224 @itemize @bullet
1225
1226 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1227 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1228 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1229 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1230 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1231 or one from a daughtercard).
1232 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1233 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1234
1235 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1236 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1237 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1238 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1239 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1240 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1241
1242 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1243 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1244 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1245 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1246 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1247
1248
1249 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1250 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1251 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1252 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1253 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1254 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1255 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1256
1257 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1258 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1259 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1260 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1261 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1262
1263 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1264 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1265 used to start booting.
1266
1267 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1268 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1269 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1270 multiple audio codec chips).
1271 This interacts with software
1272 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1273 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1274 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1275 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1276 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1277 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1278 audio or video codecs are used.
1279
1280 @end itemize
1281
1282 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1283 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1284 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1285 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1286 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1287 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1288 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1289 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1290 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1291 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1292
1293
1294 @node Config File Guidelines
1295 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1296
1297 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1298 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1299 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1300 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1301
1302 You should find the following directories under
1303 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1304 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1305 @itemize @bullet
1306 @item @file{interface} ...
1307 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1308 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1309 @item @file{board} ...
1310 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1311 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1312
1313 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1314 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1315 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1316 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1317 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1318 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1319 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1320 a CPU and an FPGA.
1321 @item @file{target} ...
1322 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1323 on a chip
1324 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1325 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1326 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1327 the target config file defines all of them.
1328 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1329 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1330 @end itemize
1331
1332 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1333 file may override features in any of the above files by
1334 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1335 commands specific to their situation.
1336
1337 @section Interface Config Files
1338
1339 The user config file
1340 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1341
1342 @example
1343 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1344 @end example
1345
1346 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1347 in use today with OpenOCD.
1348 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1349 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1350
1351 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1352 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1353 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1354 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1355 and need to provide a driver for it.
1356
1357 @section Board Config Files
1358 @cindex config file, board
1359 @cindex board config file
1360
1361 The user config file
1362 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1363
1364 @example
1365 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1366 @end example
1367
1368 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1369 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1370 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1371
1372 @enumerate
1373 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1374 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1375 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1376 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1377 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1378 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1379 @end enumerate
1380
1381 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1382 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1383 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1384 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1385
1386 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1387 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1388 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1389 configuration works.
1390
1391 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1392
1393 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1394 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1395 convention on how to use certain variables.
1396
1397 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1398 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1399 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1400 used at will within a target configuration file.
1401
1402 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1403 for a board with three chips:
1404
1405 @example
1406 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1407 set CHIPNAME network
1408 set ENDIAN big
1409 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1410 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1411 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1412 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1413
1414 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1415 set CHIPNAME video
1416 set ENDIAN little
1417 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1418 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1419 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1420 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1421
1422 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1423 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1424 unset ENDIAN
1425 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1426 @end example
1427
1428 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1429 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1430 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1431 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1432 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1433 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1434 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1435 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1436
1437 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1438 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1439 naming collisions.
1440
1441 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1442 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1443 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1444 up other clocks and peripherals.
1445
1446 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1447 @cindex variable names
1448
1449 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1450 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1451 one such chip (as shown above).
1452 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1453 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1454 to promote consistency and
1455 so that board files can override target defaults.
1456
1457 Inputs to target config files include:
1458
1459 @itemize @bullet
1460 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1461 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1462 tap identifier dotted names.
1463 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1464 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1465 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1466 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1467 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1468 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1469 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1470 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1471 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1472 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1473 @end itemize
1474
1475 Outputs from target config files include:
1476
1477 @itemize @bullet
1478 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1479 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1480 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1481 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1482 specific to that board and that target.
1483 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1484 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1485 @end itemize
1486
1487 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1488 @cindex event, reset-init
1489 @cindex reset-init handler
1490
1491 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1492 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1493 fully set up yet.
1494 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1495 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1496 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1497 handler is one of the most important.
1498
1499 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1500 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1501 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1502 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1503 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1504
1505 @quotation Note
1506 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1507 are included here.
1508 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1509 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1510 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1511 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1512 @end quotation
1513
1514 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1515 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1516 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1517 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1518 those as parameters.
1519 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1520 and disabling the watchdog.
1521 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1522 the next developer doing such work.
1523 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1524
1525 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1526 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1527 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1528 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1529
1530 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1531
1532 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1533 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1534 a low JTAG clock rate.
1535 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1536 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1537 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1538 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1539 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1540 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1541 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1542
1543 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1544 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1545 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1546 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1547 which might be less than that.
1548
1549 @quotation Warning
1550 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1551 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1552 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1553 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1554 @end quotation
1555
1556 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1557 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1558 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1559 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1560 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1561 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1562
1563 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1564 @subsection The init_board procedure
1565 @cindex init_board procedure
1566
1567 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1568 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1569 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1570 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1571 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1572 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1573 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1574 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1575 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1576 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1577 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1578 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1579
1580 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1581 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1582
1583 @example
1584 ### board_file.cfg ###
1585
1586 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1587 source [find target/target.cfg]
1588
1589 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1590 # enables fast on-board clock source
1591 # configures the chip to use it
1592 @}
1593
1594 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1595 proc init_board @{@} @{
1596 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1597
1598 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1599 adapter_khz 100
1600 @}
1601
1602 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1603 enable_fast_clock
1604 adapter_khz 10000
1605 @}
1606 @}
1607 @end example
1608
1609 @section Target Config Files
1610 @cindex config file, target
1611 @cindex target config file
1612
1613 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1614 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1615 more target config files like this:
1616
1617 @example
1618 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1619 @end example
1620
1621 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1622 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1623 In summary the target files should contain
1624
1625 @enumerate
1626 @item Set defaults
1627 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1628 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1629 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1630 @item On-Chip flash
1631 @end enumerate
1632
1633 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1634 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1635 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1636
1637 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1638 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1639 can talk to the chip.
1640 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1641 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1642 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1643 and other processing engines.
1644
1645 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1646
1647 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1648 letting board config files express environment-specific
1649 differences in how things should be set up.
1650
1651 @example
1652 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1653 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1654 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1655 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1658 @}
1659
1660 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1661 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1662 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1663 @} else @{
1664 set _ENDIAN little
1665 @}
1666
1667 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1668 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1669 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1670 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1671 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1672 @} else @{
1673 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1674 @}
1675 @end example
1676 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1677
1678 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1679 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1680 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1681
1682 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1683 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1684 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1685
1686 @example
1687 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1688 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1689 @end example
1690
1691 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1692 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1693 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1694 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1695 for taps.
1696
1697 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1698 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1699 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1700 looks (in part) like this:
1701
1702 @example
1703 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1704 @end example
1705
1706 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1707 to source such a config file twice, with different
1708 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1709 it adds a different TAP each time.
1710
1711 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1712 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1713 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1714 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1715
1716 @example
1717 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1718 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1719 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1720 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1721 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1722 @end example
1723
1724 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1725 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1726
1727 @itemize
1728 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1729 plus a JRC to enable them
1730 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1731 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1732 is not currently used)
1733 @end itemize
1734
1735 @subsection Add CPU targets
1736
1737 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1738 GDB and other commands can use it.
1739 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1740 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1741 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1742 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1743
1744 @example
1745 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1746 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1747 @end example
1748
1749 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1750 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1751 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1752 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1753 a work area if you can.
1754 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1755
1756 @example
1757 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1758 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1759 @end example
1760
1761 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1762 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1763 @cindex SMP
1764 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1765
1766 @example
1767 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1769 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1770 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1771 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1772 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1773 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1774 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1775 @end example
1776 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1777 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1778 @itemize @bullet
1779 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1780 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1781 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1782 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1783 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1784 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1785 @end itemize
1786
1787 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1788 command have been implemented.
1789 @itemize @bullet
1790 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1791 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1792 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1793 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1794 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1795 following example.
1796 @end itemize
1797
1798 @example
1799 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1800 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1801 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1802 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1803 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1804 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1805 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1806 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1807 > resume
1808 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1809 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1810 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1811 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1812 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1813 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1814 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1815 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1816 @end example
1817
1818
1819 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1820
1821 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1822 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1823 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1824
1825 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1826 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1827 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1828 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1829 both signals.
1830
1831 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1832 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1833 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1834 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1835 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1836 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1837 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1838 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1839 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1840 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1841 not available.)
1842
1843 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1844 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1845 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1846 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1847 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1848 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1849 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1850 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1851
1852 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1853 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1854 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1855 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1856 slower clock than they will use later.
1857 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1858 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1859 than they will use later.
1860 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1861
1862 @quotation Important
1863 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1864 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1865 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1866 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1867 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1868 @end quotation
1869
1870 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1871 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1872 @cindex init_targets procedure
1873
1874 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1875 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1876 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1877 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1878 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1879 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1880 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1881 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1882 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1883
1884 @example
1885 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1886
1887 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1888 # basic initialization procedure ...
1889 @}
1890
1891 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1892 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1893 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1894 @}
1895
1896 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1897
1898 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1899
1900 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1901 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1902 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1903 @}
1904 @end example
1905
1906 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1907 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1908
1909 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1910
1911 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1912 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1913
1914 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1915 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1916 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1917
1918 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1919 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1920 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1921 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1922 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1923 events already assigned.
1924
1925 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1926
1927 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1928 special high speed download features - enable it.
1929
1930 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1931
1932 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1933 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1934 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1935 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1936 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1937 If you are using an external trace port,
1938 configure it in your board config file.
1939 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1940 configure it in your target config file.
1941
1942 @example
1943 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1944 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1945 @end example
1946
1947 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1948
1949 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1950
1951 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1952 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1953 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1954 the TARGET (chip) file.
1955
1956 Examples:
1957 @itemize @bullet
1958 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1959 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1960 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1961 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1962 @end itemize
1963
1964 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1965 @section Translating Configuration Files
1966 @cindex translation
1967 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1968 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1969 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1970 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1971 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1972 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1973
1974 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1975 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1976 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1977 convert other scripts later on.
1978
1979 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1980 replace job:
1981
1982 @example
1983 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1984 #
1985 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1986 #
1987 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1988 #
1989 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1990
1991 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1992 global TARGETNAME
1993
1994 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1995
1996 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1997 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1998 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1999 @}
2000 @end example
2001
2002
2003
2004 @node Server Configuration
2005 @chapter Server Configuration
2006 @cindex initialization
2007 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2008 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2009 supported.
2010
2011 @anchor{configurationstage}
2012 @section Configuration Stage
2013 @cindex configuration stage
2014 @cindex config command
2015
2016 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2017 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2018 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2019 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2020 inside startup scripts.
2021
2022 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2023 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2024 which may be issued interactively.
2025 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2026 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2027
2028 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2029 flash banks,
2030 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2031 and other basic setup.
2032 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2033 may access or activate TAPs.
2034 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2035 longer be issued.
2036
2037 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2038 @section Entering the Run Stage
2039
2040 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2041 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2042 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2043 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2044 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2045 You should see no errors at this point.
2046 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2047 commands you used to configure the server.
2048 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2049 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2050 on the scan chain.
2051
2052 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2053 become available.
2054 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2055 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2056 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2057 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2058 entry to the run stage.
2059
2060 @deffn {Config Command} init
2061 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2062 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2063 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2064 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2065 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2066 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2067
2068 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2069 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2070 configuration files and/or command line options.
2071
2072 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2073 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2074 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2075 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2076 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2077 @end deffn
2078
2079 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2080 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2081 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2082
2083 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2084 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2085 scan chain.
2086 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2087 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2088
2089 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2090 they return.
2091 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2092 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2093 @end deffn
2094
2095 @anchor{tcpipports}
2096 @section TCP/IP Ports
2097 @cindex TCP port
2098 @cindex server
2099 @cindex port
2100 @cindex security
2101 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2102 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2103 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2104
2105 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2106 access using one or more of these ports.
2107 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2108 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2109 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2110
2111 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2112 @cindex GDB server
2113 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2114 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2115 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2116 the normal use cases.
2117
2118 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2119 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2120 disables the gdb server.
2121
2122 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2123 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2124
2125 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2126 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2127
2128 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2129 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2130 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2131
2132 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2133 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2134 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2135 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2136
2137 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2138 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2139 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2140
2141 @end deffn
2142
2143 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2144 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2145 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2146 output from the Tcl engine.
2147 Intended as a machine interface.
2148 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2149 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2150 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2151 @end deffn
2152
2153 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2154 Specify or query the
2155 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2156 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2157 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2158 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2159 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2160 @end deffn
2161
2162 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2163 @section GDB Configuration
2164 @cindex GDB
2165 @cindex GDB configuration
2166 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2167 The ones listed here are static and global.
2168 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2169 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2170
2171 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2172 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2173 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2174 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2175 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2176 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2177 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2181 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2182 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2183 vFlash packet is received.
2184 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2185 @end deffn
2186
2187 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2188 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2189 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2190 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2191 for flash programming to work.
2192 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2198 by GDB memory read packets.
2199 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2200 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2201 @end deffn
2202
2203 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2204 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2205 packets report errors or not.
2206 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2207 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2211 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2212 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2213 @end deffn
2214
2215 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2216 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2217
2218 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2219 @end deffn
2220
2221 @anchor{eventpolling}
2222 @section Event Polling
2223
2224 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2225 where significant events can happen at any time.
2226 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2227 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2228 or to GDB.
2229
2230 Examples of such events include:
2231
2232 @itemize
2233 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2234 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2235 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2236 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2237 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2238 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2239 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2240 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2241 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2242 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2243 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2244 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2245 @end itemize
2246
2247 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2248 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2249 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2250 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2251 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2252
2253 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2254 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2255 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2256 to the various active targets.
2257 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2258 which is normally done in the background.
2259
2260 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2261 Poll the current target for its current state.
2262 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2263 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2264 specific information about the current state is printed.
2265 An optional parameter
2266 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2267
2268 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2269 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2270 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2271 @example
2272 > poll
2273 background polling: on
2274 target state: halted
2275 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2276 current mode: Supervisor
2277 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2278 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2279 >
2280 @end example
2281 @end deffn
2282
2283 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2284 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2285 @cindex config file, interface
2286 @cindex interface config file
2287
2288 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2289 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2290 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2291
2292 @quotation Note
2293 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2294 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2295 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2296 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2297 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2298 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2299 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2300 @end quotation
2301
2302 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2303 through commands in an interface configuration
2304 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2305 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2306
2307 @example
2308 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2309 @end example
2310
2311 These commands tell
2312 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2313 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2314
2315 @example
2316 # jlink interface
2317 interface jlink
2318 @end example
2319
2320 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2321
2322
2323 @section Interface Configuration
2324
2325 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2326 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2327 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2328
2329 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2330 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2331 target.
2332 @end deffn
2333
2334 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2335 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2336 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2337 @end deffn
2338 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2339 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2340 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2341 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2342 the hardware can support.
2343 @end deffn
2344
2345
2346
2347 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2348 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2349 @end deffn
2350
2351 @section Interface Drivers
2352
2353 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2354 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2355 available at run time.
2356
2357 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2358 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2359 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2360 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2361
2362 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2363 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2364 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2365 @end deffn
2366
2367 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2368 Displays status of RTCK option.
2369 Optionally sets that option first.
2370 @end deffn
2371 @end deffn
2372
2373 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2374 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2375 This has one driver-specific command:
2376
2377 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2378 Logs some status
2379 @end deffn
2380 @end deffn
2381
2382 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2383 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2384 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2385 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2386 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2387 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2388 @end deffn
2389
2390 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2391 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2392
2393 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2394 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2395 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2396 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2397 @example
2398 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2399 @end example
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2403 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2404 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2405 @end deffn
2406
2407 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2408 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2409 @end deffn
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2413 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2414 @end deffn
2415
2416 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2417 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2418 @end deffn
2419
2420 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2421 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2422 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2423
2424 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2425 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2426
2427 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added competely through
2428 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2429
2430 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2431 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2432 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2433 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2434 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2435 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2436
2437 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2438 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2439 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2440 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2441 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2442
2443 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2444 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2445 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2446 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2447
2448 @itemize @minus
2449 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2450 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2451 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2452 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2453 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2454 switching data and direction as necessary
2455 @end itemize
2456
2457 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2458 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2459
2460 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2461 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2462 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2463 @example
2464 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2465 @end example
2466 @end deffn
2467
2468 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2469 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2470 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2471 during device selection.
2472 @end deffn
2473
2474 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2475 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2476 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2477 is connected to the host.
2478 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2479 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2480 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2481 @end deffn
2482
2483 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2484 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2485 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2486 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2487 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2488 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2489
2490 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2491 @end deffn
2492
2493 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2494 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2495 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2496 @end deffn
2497
2498 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2499 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2500 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2501 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2502 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2503 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2504 and initially asserted reset signals.
2505 @end deffn
2506
2507 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2508 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2509 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2510 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2511 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2512 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2513 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2514 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2515 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2516 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2517 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2518
2519 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2520 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2521 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2522 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2523 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2524 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2525
2526 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2527 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2528 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2529 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2530 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2531 are always driven by the FTDI.
2532
2533 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2534 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2535 @var{name}.
2536 @end deffn
2537
2538 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2539 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2540 @itemize @minus
2541 @item @option{0}, drive low
2542 @item @option{1}, drive high
2543 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2544 @end itemize
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2548 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2549 @end deffn
2550
2551 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2552 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2553
2554 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2555 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2556 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2557 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2558 @itemize @minus
2559 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2560 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2561 @end itemize
2562 @end deffn
2563
2564 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2565 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2566
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2570 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R
2571 USB UART bridge IC.
2572
2573 List of connections (pin numbers for SSOP):
2574 @itemize @minus
2575 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2576 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2577 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2578 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2579 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2580 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2581 @end itemize
2582
2583 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2584 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2585
2586 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2587 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2588 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2589 @end deffn
2590
2591 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2592 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2593 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2594 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2595 @end deffn
2596
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2600 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2601 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2602 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2603
2604 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2605 processors which are being simulated.
2606
2607 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2608 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2609 sockets instead of TCP.
2610 @end deffn
2611
2612 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2613 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2614 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2615 @end deffn
2616
2617 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2618 something like:
2619
2620 @example
2621 interface remote_bitbang
2622 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2623 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2624 @end example
2625
2626 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2627 named mysocket:
2628
2629 @example
2630 interface remote_bitbang
2631 remote_bitbang_port 0
2632 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2633 @end example
2634 @end deffn
2635
2636 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2637 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2638 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2639 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2640
2641 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2642 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2643 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2644 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2645 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2649 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2650 default values are used.
2651 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2652 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2653 @example
2654 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2655 @end example
2656 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2657 @example
2658 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2659 @end example
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2663 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2664 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2665 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2666 target board.
2667
2668 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2669 @example
2670 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2671 reset_config srst_only
2672 @end example
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2676 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2677 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2678 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2679 @end deffn
2680
2681 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2682 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2683 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2684 @end deffn
2685
2686 @end deffn
2687
2688 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2689 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2690 This has one driver-specific command:
2691
2692 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2693 Display either the address of the I/O port
2694 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2695 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2696 This is a write-once setting.
2697 @end deffn
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2701 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2702 transports.
2703
2704 @quotation Compatibility Note
2705 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2706 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2707 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2708 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2709 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2710 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2711 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2712 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2713 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2714 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2715 @end quotation
2716
2717 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2718 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2719 states.
2720 @end deffn
2721 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2722 Display free device internal memory.
2723 @end deffn
2724 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2725 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2726 command version.
2727 @end deffn
2728 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2729 Display the device configuration.
2730 @end deffn
2731 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2732 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2733 power state.
2734 @end deffn
2735 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2736 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2737 @end deffn
2738 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2739 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2740 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2741 IP configuration.
2742 @end deffn
2743 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2744 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2745 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2746 @end deffn
2747 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2748 Reset the current configuration.
2749 @end deffn
2750 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2751 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2752 @end deffn
2753 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2754 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2755 pairs.
2756
2757 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2758 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2759 @example
2760 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2761 @end example
2762 @end deffn
2763 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2764 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2765 pairs.
2766
2767 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2768 @example
2769 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2770 77a90000
2771 @end example
2772 @end deffn
2773 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2774 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2775 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2776 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2777 instead.
2778
2779 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2780 @end deffn
2781 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2782 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2783 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2784
2785 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2786 @end deffn
2787 @end deffn
2788
2789 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2790 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2791 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2792 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2793 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2794 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2795 configuration script.
2796
2797 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2798 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2799 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2800 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2801 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2802
2803 Known limitations:
2804 @itemize @bullet
2805 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2806 and 2.7 MHz.
2807 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2808 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2809 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2810 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2811 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2812 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2813 communications with the target.
2814 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2815 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2816 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2817 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2818 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2819 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2820 @end itemize
2821
2822 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2823 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2824 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2825 @end deffn
2826
2827 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2828 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2829 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2830 @end deffn
2831
2832 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2833 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2834 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2835 target as a side-effect.
2836 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2837 @end deffn
2838
2839 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2840 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2841 version, and target voltage.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @end deffn
2844
2845 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2846 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2847 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2848 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2849 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2850
2851 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2852 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2853 This is a write-once setting.
2854 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2855
2856 @itemize @minus
2857 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2858 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2859 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2860 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2861 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2862 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2863 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2864 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2865 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2866 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2867 some versions of
2868 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2869 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2870 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2871 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2872 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2873 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2874 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2875 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2876 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2877 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2878 @end itemize
2879 @end deffn
2880
2881 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2882 Display either the address of the I/O port
2883 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2884 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2885 This is a write-once setting.
2886
2887 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2888 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2889 you may encounter a problem.
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2893 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2894 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2895 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2896 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2897 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2898
2899 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2900 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2901 @quotation Tip
2902 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2903 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2904 @example
2905 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2906 > adapter_khz 500
2907 @end example
2908 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2909 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2910 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2911 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2912 large set of samples.
2913 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2914 @example
2915 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2916 @end example
2917 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2918 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2919
2920 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2921 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2922 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2923 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2924 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2925 @end quotation
2926 @end deffn
2927
2928 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2929 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2930 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2934 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2935
2936 @example
2937 interface parport
2938 parport_port 0x278
2939 parport_cable wiggler
2940 @end example
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2944 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2945 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2946 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2947 @end deffn
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2951 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2952 @end deffn
2953
2954 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2955 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2956 @end deffn
2957
2958 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2959 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2960
2961 @quotation Note
2962 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2963 which are not currently documented here.
2964 @end quotation
2965 @end deffn
2966
2967 @anchor{hla_interface}
2968 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2969 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2970 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2971 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2972
2973 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2974 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2975 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2976 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2977 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2978
2979 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2980 Currently Not Supported.
2981 @end deffn
2982
2983 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2984 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2985 @end deffn
2986
2987 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2988 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2989 @end deffn
2990
2991 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2992 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
2993 @end deffn
2994
2995 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2996 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2997 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2998 @end deffn
2999 @end deffn
3000
3001 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3002 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3003 @end deffn
3004
3005 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3006 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3007 @end deffn
3008
3009 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3010 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3011 @end deffn
3012
3013 @quotation Note
3014 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3015 which are not currently documented here.
3016 @end quotation
3017
3018 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3019 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3020 No arguments: print status.
3021 @end deffn
3022
3023 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3024 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3025 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3026
3027 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3028 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3029 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3030 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3031 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3032 configuration on exit.
3033
3034 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3035 pinout.
3036
3037 @end deffn
3038
3039 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3040 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3041 of the one which is most popular.
3042
3043 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3044
3045 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3046 pinout.
3047
3048 @end deffn
3049
3050
3051 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3052 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3053 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3054
3055 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3056 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3057 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3058
3059 @itemize @minus
3060 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3061 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3062 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3063 @end itemize
3064 @end deffn
3065
3066 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3067 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3068 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3069 @end deffn
3070 @end deffn
3071
3072 @section Transport Configuration
3073 @cindex Transport
3074 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3075 and the debug adapter you are using,
3076 several transports may be available to
3077 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3078 @deffn Command {transport list}
3079 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3080 version of OpenOCD.
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3084 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3085
3086 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3087 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3088 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3089 adapter's driver).
3090
3091 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3092 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3093 supported by the debug adapter.
3094
3095 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3096 transport, if any.
3097 @end deffn
3098
3099 @subsection JTAG Transport
3100 @cindex JTAG
3101 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3102 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3103 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3104 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3105 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3106 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3107
3108 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3109 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3110 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3111 hla_jtag}.
3112
3113 @subsection SWD Transport
3114 @cindex SWD
3115 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3116 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3117 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3118 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3119 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3120 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3121 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3122
3123 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3124 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3125 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3126 hla_swd}.
3127
3128 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3129 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3130 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3131 expected to change.
3132 @end deffn
3133 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3134 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3135 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3136 No parameters: displays current settings.
3137 @end deffn
3138
3139 @subsection SPI Transport
3140 @cindex SPI
3141 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3142 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3143 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3144 solution for flash programming.
3145
3146 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3147 @section JTAG Speed
3148 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3149 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3150 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3151 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3152 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3153 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3154 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3155 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3156 power management software that may be active.
3157
3158 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3159 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3160 target event handler.
3161 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3162 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3163 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3164 sets up those clocks).
3165 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3166 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3167 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3168 in the target config file.
3169 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3170 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3171 config file instead.
3172 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3173 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3174 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3175
3176 @example
3177 jtag_rclk 3000
3178 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3179 @end example
3180
3181 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3182 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3183 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3184 may not be the fastest solution.
3185
3186 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3187 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3188 which support adaptive clocking.
3189
3190 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3191 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3192 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3193 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3194 than the speed specified.
3195
3196 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3197 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3198 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3199 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3200
3201 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3202 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3203 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3204 JTAG clocking after setup.
3205 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3206 If the interface device can not
3207 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3208 @end deffn
3209
3210 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3211 @cindex adaptive clocking
3212 @cindex RTCK
3213 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3214 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3215 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3216 @example
3217 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3218 jtag_rclk 3000
3219 @end example
3220 @end defun
3221
3222 @node Reset Configuration
3223 @chapter Reset Configuration
3224 @cindex Reset Configuration
3225
3226 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3227 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3228 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3229 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3230 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3231 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3232 Please see the various board files for examples.
3233
3234 @quotation Note
3235 To maintainers and integrators:
3236 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3237 Normally the board configuration file
3238 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3239 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3240
3241 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3242 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3243 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3244 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3245 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3246 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3247 @end quotation
3248
3249 @section Types of Reset
3250
3251 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3252 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3253 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3254
3255 @itemize @bullet
3256 @item
3257 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3258 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3259 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3260 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3261 @item
3262 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3263 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3264 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3265 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3266 @item
3267 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3268 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3269 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3270 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3271 @item
3272 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3273 several other types of reset.
3274 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3275 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3276 There may be individual module resets.
3277 @end itemize
3278
3279 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3280 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3281 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3282 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3283 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3284 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3285 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3286 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3287 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3288
3289 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3290 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3291
3292 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3293 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3294 common issues are:
3295
3296 @itemize @bullet
3297
3298 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3299 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3300 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3301 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3302 when either of those signals is not connected.
3303 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3304 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3305 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3306 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3307
3308 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3309 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3310 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3311 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3312
3313 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3314 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3315 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3316 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3317 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3318 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3319 hardware debouncing.
3320 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3321 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3322
3323 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3324 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3325 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3326 to use push/pull output drivers.
3327 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3328 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3329 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3330 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3331
3332 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3333 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3334 issues (not limited to errata).
3335 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3336 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3337 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3338 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3339 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3340 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3341 @end itemize
3342
3343 There can also be other issues.
3344 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3345 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3346 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3347 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3348 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3349 Agreement (NDA).
3350
3351 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3352 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3353 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3354
3355 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3356 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3357
3358 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3359
3360 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3361 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3362 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3363 allowing it to be deasserted.
3364 @end deffn
3365
3366 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3367 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3368 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3369 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3370 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3371 @end deffn
3372
3373 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3374 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3375 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3376 allowing it to be deasserted.
3377 @end deffn
3378
3379 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3380 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3381 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3382 @end deffn
3383
3384 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3385 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3386 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3387 configuration scripts.
3388
3389 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3390 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3391 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3392 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3393 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3394 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3395 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3396 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3397
3398 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3399 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3400 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3401 -- may be specified at a time.
3402 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3403 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3404 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3405 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3406 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3407
3408 @itemize
3409 @item
3410 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3411 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3412 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3413 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3414 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3415
3416 @quotation Tip
3417 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3418 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3419 @end quotation
3420
3421 @item
3422 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3423 signal implementations.
3424 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3425 indicating everything behaves normally.
3426 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3427 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3428 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3429 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3430 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3431 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3432 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3433
3434 @item
3435 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3436 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3437 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3438 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3439 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3440 while SRST is asserted.
3441 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3442 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3443
3444 @item
3445 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3446 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3447 is required to use this option.
3448 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3449 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3450 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3451 be asserted before any target connection.
3452 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3453 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3454 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3455 @end itemize
3456
3457 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3458 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3459 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3460 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3461 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3462
3463 @itemize
3464 @item
3465 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3466 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3467 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3468 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3469
3470 @item
3471 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3472 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3473 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3474 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3475 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3476 @end itemize
3477 @end deffn
3478
3479 @section Custom Reset Handling
3480 @cindex events
3481
3482 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3483 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3484 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3485 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3486 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3487 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3488
3489 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3490 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3491 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3492 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3493 want to reset everything at once.
3494
3495 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3496 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3497 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3498 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3499 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3500 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3501 needs special attention.
3502
3503 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3504 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3505 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3506 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3507 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3508 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3509 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3510 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3511
3512 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3513 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3514 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3515 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3516 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3517
3518 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3519 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3520 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3521 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3522 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3523 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3524 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3525 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3526 or potentially some other value.
3527
3528 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3529 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3530 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3531 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3532 (or their associated targets)
3533 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3534
3535 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3536 they return.
3537 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3538 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3539 @end deffn
3540
3541 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3542 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3543 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3544 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3545 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3546 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3547 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3548 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3549 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3550 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3551 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3552 @end deffn
3553
3554 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3555 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3556 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3557 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3558 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3559 @end deffn
3560
3561
3562 @node TAP Declaration
3563 @chapter TAP Declaration
3564 @cindex TAP declaration
3565 @cindex TAP configuration
3566
3567 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3568 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3569
3570 @itemize @bullet
3571 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3572 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3573 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3574 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3575 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3576 start running that code.
3577 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3578 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3579 and missing connections.
3580 @end itemize
3581
3582 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3583 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3584 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3585 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3586 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3587
3588 @section Scan Chains
3589 @cindex scan chain
3590
3591 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3592 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3593 They also need to be added to
3594 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3595 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3596 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3597 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3598 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3599 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3600 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3601 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3602
3603 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3604 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3605 command, presented in the next chapter.
3606 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3607 debugging targets.)
3608 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3609
3610 @verbatim
3611 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3612 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3613 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3614 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3615 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3616 @end verbatim
3617
3618 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3619 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3620 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3621 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3622 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3623 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3624 until they are told to do so.
3625
3626 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3627 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3628 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3629 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3630
3631 @example
3632 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3633 @end example
3634
3635 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3636 by a given chip.
3637 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3638 and so forth.
3639 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3640 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3641 both inside a single chip and between them.
3642 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3643
3644 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3645 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3646 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3647 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3648 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3649 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3650 includes commands something like this:
3651
3652 @example
3653 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3654 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3655 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3656 @end example
3657
3658 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3659 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3660 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3661
3662 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3663 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3664 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3665 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3666 @example
3667 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3668 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3669 @}
3670 @end example
3671 @end deffn
3672
3673 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3674 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3675 and their status.
3676 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3677 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3678 but systems with a JTAG router can
3679 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3680 @end deffn
3681
3682 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3683 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3684
3685 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3686 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3687
3688 @section TAP Names
3689 @cindex dotted name
3690
3691 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3692 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3693 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3694 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3695 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3696 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3697 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3698 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3699
3700 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3701 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3702 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3703
3704 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3705
3706 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3707 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3708 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3709 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3710
3711 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3712 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3713 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3714 overridable.
3715
3716 @cindex TAP naming convention
3717 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3718 and should follow this convention:
3719
3720 @itemize @bullet
3721 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3722 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3723 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3724 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3725 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3726 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3727 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3728 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3729 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3730 with a single TAP;
3731 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3732 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3733 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3734 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3735 @end itemize
3736
3737 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3738
3739 @itemize @bullet
3740 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3741 @*The length in bits of the
3742 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3743 @end itemize
3744
3745 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3746
3747 @itemize @bullet
3748 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3749 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3750 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3751 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3752 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3753 (the TAP is linked in).
3754 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3755 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3756 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3757 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3758 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3759 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3760 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3761 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3762 values that were found but not included in the list.
3763
3764 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3765 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3766 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3767 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3768 hardware to find these values.
3769 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3770 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3771 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3772 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3773 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3774 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3775 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3776 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3777 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3778 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3779 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3780 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3781 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3782 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3783 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3784 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3785 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3786 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3787 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3788 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3789 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3790 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3791 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3792 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3793 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3794 @end itemize
3795 @end deffn
3796
3797 @section Other TAP commands
3798
3799 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3800 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3801 At this writing this TAP attribute
3802 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3803 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3804 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3805 See the next section for information about the available events.
3806
3807 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3808 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3809 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3810 @end deffn
3811
3812 @section TAP Events
3813 @cindex events
3814 @cindex TAP events
3815
3816 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3817 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3818 The other applies to debugger targets,
3819 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3820
3821 The TAP events currently defined are:
3822
3823 @itemize @bullet
3824 @item @b{post-reset}
3825 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3826 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3827 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3828 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3829 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3830
3831 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3832 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3833 of any particular target.
3834 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3835 @item @b{setup}
3836 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3837 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3838 @item @b{tap-disable}
3839 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3840 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3841 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3842 @item @b{tap-enable}
3843 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3844 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3845 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3846 @end itemize
3847
3848 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3849 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3850 contents to be accurate), you might:
3851
3852 @example
3853 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3854 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3855 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3856 @}
3857 @end example
3858
3859
3860 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3861 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3862 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3863 @cindex jrc
3864
3865 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3866 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3867 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3868 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3869 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3870
3871 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3872 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3873 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3874 be visible.
3875 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3876 ignores, such as:
3877
3878 @itemize
3879 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3880 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3881 TAPs receive new instructions.
3882 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3883 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3884 @end itemize
3885
3886 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3887 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3888 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3889 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3890
3891 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3892 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3893
3894 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3895 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3896 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3897 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3898 should define TAP event handlers using
3899 code that looks something like this:
3900
3901 @example
3902 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3903 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3904 @}
3905 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3906 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3907 @}
3908 @end example
3909
3910 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3911
3912 @example
3913 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3914 @end example
3915
3916 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3917 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3918 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3919 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3920
3921 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3922 If necessary, disables the tap
3923 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3924 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3925 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3926 and "0" if it is disabled.
3927 @end deffn
3928
3929 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3930 If necessary, enables the tap
3931 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3932 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3933 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3934 and "0" if it is disabled.
3935 @end deffn
3936
3937 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3938 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3939 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3940 and "0" if it is disabled.
3941
3942 @quotation Note
3943 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3944 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3945 @end quotation
3946 @end deffn
3947
3948 @anchor{autoprobing}
3949 @section Autoprobing
3950 @cindex autoprobe
3951 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3952
3953 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3954 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3955 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3956 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3957
3958 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3959 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3960 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3961 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3962 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3963 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3964 right when they come out of reset).
3965
3966 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3967
3968 @example
3969 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3970 reset_config trst_and_srst
3971 jtag_rclk 8
3972 @end example
3973
3974 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3975 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3976
3977 @enumerate
3978 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3979 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3980 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3981 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3982 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3983 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3984 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3985 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3986 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3987 that is discovered.
3988 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3989 register, it will report it.
3990 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3991 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3992 @end enumerate
3993
3994 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3995 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3996 that's a bit more complex:
3997
3998 @example
3999 clock speed 8 kHz
4000 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4001 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4002 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4003 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4004 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4005 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4006 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4007 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4008 @end example
4009
4010 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4011 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4012 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4013 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4014 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4015 and so forth.
4016
4017 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4018 @section DAP declaration (ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4019 @cindex DAP declaration
4020
4021 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4022 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4023 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all
4024 ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4025 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4026
4027 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4028
4029 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4030 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4031 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4032 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4033 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4034
4035 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4036
4037 @itemize @bullet
4038 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4039 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4040 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4041 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4042 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4043 @end itemize
4044 @end deffn
4045
4046 @deffn Command {dap names}
4047 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4048 for TCL scripting.
4049 @end deffn
4050
4051 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4052 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4053 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4054 @end deffn
4055
4056 @deffn Command {dap init}
4057 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4058 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4059 initialization, too.
4060 @end deffn
4061
4062 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4063
4064 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4065 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4066 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4067 @end deffn
4068
4069 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4070 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4071 @end deffn
4072
4073 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4074 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4075 or set a new value @var{value}.
4076 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4077 @end deffn
4078
4079 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4080 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4081 @end deffn
4082
4083 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4084 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4085 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4086 @end deffn
4087
4088 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4089 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4090 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4091 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4092 @end deffn
4093
4094 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [0 / 1]
4095 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
4096 Defaulting to 0.
4097 @end deffn
4098
4099 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4100 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4101 Disabled by default
4102 @end deffn
4103
4104
4105 @node CPU Configuration
4106 @chapter CPU Configuration
4107 @cindex GDB target
4108
4109 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4110 You can also access these targets without GDB
4111 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4112 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4113 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4114 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4115
4116 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4117 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4118
4119 @section Target List
4120 @cindex target, current
4121 @cindex target, list
4122
4123 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4124 where each member has a name.
4125 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4126 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4127 (plural!) command.
4128 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4129 look like with more than one:
4130 @verbatim
4131 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4132 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4133 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4134 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4135 @end verbatim
4136
4137 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4138 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4139 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4140 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4141 space seen by that current target.
4142 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4143 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4144 are examples; and there are many more.
4145
4146 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4147
4148 @deffn Command {target current}
4149 Returns the name of the current target.
4150 @end deffn
4151
4152 @deffn Command {target names}
4153 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4154 @example
4155 foreach t [target names] @{
4156 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4157 @}
4158 @end example
4159 @end deffn
4160
4161 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4162 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4163
4164 @deffn Command targets [name]
4165 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4166 command names are singular.}
4167
4168 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4169 targets in a user friendly form.
4170
4171 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4172 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4173 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4174 @end deffn
4175
4176 @section Target CPU Types
4177 @cindex target type
4178 @cindex CPU type
4179
4180 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4181 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4182 when calling @command{target create}.
4183 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4184 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4185 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4186 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4187 what core-specific commands may be available
4188 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4189 and more.
4190
4191 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4192 since there's a command to list them.
4193
4194 @anchor{targettypes}
4195 @deffn Command {target types}
4196 Lists all supported target types.
4197 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4198
4199 @itemize @bullet
4200 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4201 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4202 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4203 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4204 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4205 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4206 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4207 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4208 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4209 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4210 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4211 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4212 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4213 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4214 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4215 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4216 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4217 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4218 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4219 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4220 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4221 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4222 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4223 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4224 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4225 @itemize @minus
4226 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4227 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4228 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4229 @end itemize
4230 And two debug interfaces cores:
4231 @itemize @minus
4232 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4233 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4234 @end itemize
4235 @end itemize
4236 @end deffn
4237
4238 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4239 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4240 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4241 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4242 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4243 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4244 reflect design generations;
4245 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4246 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4247
4248 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4249 @section Target Configuration
4250
4251 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4252 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4253 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4254 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4255 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4256
4257 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4258 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4259 optional parts.
4260 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4261 command, created as part of target creation.
4262
4263 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4264 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4265 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4266 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4267 to be much more board-specific.
4268 The key steps you use might look something like this
4269
4270 @example
4271 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4272 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4273 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4274 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4275 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4276 @end example
4277
4278 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4279 on-chip SRAM.
4280 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4281 writes to target memory;
4282 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4283 GDB memory checksumming;
4284 and more.
4285
4286 @quotation Warning
4287 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4288 inaccessible when application code
4289 (such as an operating system)
4290 enables or disables the MMU.
4291 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4292 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4293 easy access to other addresses needed.
4294 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4295 @end quotation
4296
4297 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4298 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4299 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4300 controllers.
4301 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4302 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4303 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4304
4305 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4306 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4307 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4308 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4309 purposes including additional configuration.
4310
4311 @itemize @bullet
4312 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4313 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4314 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4315 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4316
4317 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4318 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4319 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4320 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4321 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4322 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4323 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4324
4325 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4326 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4327 @end itemize
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4331 The options accepted by this command may also be
4332 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4333 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4334 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4335
4336 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4337 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4338 and changing its endianness.
4339
4340 @itemize @bullet
4341
4342 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4343 used to access this target.
4344
4345 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4346 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4347 create and manage DAP instances.
4348
4349 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4350 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4351
4352 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4353 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4354 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4355 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4356 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4357 same event name assigns only one handler.
4358
4359 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4360 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4361
4362 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4363 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4364 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4365 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4366 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4367 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4368 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4369
4370 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4371 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4372 or virtual address is being used.
4373
4374 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4375 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4376
4377 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4378 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4379 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4380 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4381 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4382
4383 @anchor{rtostype}
4384 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4385 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4386 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4387 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}
4388 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4389
4390 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4391 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4392 access the target for debugging.
4393
4394 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4395 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4396 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4397 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4398
4399 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4400 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4401 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4402 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4403 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4404 @end itemize
4405 @end deffn
4406
4407 @section Other $target_name Commands
4408 @cindex object command
4409
4410 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4411 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4412
4413 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4414 Once a button is created a button
4415 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4416 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4417 configure it like this:
4418
4419 @example
4420 # Create
4421 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4422 # Modify
4423 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4424 # Query
4425 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4426 # Report
4427 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4428 @end example
4429
4430 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4431 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4432
4433 @example
4434 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4435 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4436 @end example
4437
4438 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4439
4440 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4441 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4442 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4443 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4444 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4445 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4446 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4447 They are not otherwise documented here.
4448 @end deffn
4449
4450 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4451 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4452 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4453 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4454 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4455 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4456 the target side uses raw memory.
4457
4458 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4459 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4460 The script orientation comes from working with data
4461 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4462 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4463 and neither store nor return those values.
4464
4465 @itemize
4466 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4467 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4468 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4469 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4470 @end itemize
4471 @end deffn
4472
4473 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4474 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4475 @command{$target_name configure}
4476 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4477 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4478 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4479 There are a few special cases:
4480
4481 @itemize @bullet
4482 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4483 event named @var{event_name}.
4484 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4485 two parameters.
4486 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4487 This is a special case because this is set using
4488 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4489 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4490 @end itemize
4491
4492 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4493 all the targets you might use something like this:
4494
4495 @example
4496 foreach name [target names] @{
4497 set y [$name cget -endian]
4498 set z [$name cget -type]
4499 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4500 $x $name $y $z]
4501 @}
4502 @end example
4503 @end deffn
4504
4505 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4506 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4507 Displays the current target state:
4508 @code{debug-running},
4509 @code{halted},
4510 @code{reset},
4511 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4512 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4513 @end deffn
4514
4515 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4516 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4517 currently associated with this target.
4518 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4519 @end deffn
4520
4521 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4522 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4523 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4524 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4525 @end deffn
4526
4527 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4528 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4529 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4530 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4531 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4532 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4533 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4534 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4535 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4536 @end deffn
4537
4538 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4539 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4540 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4541 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4542 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4543 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4544 @end deffn
4545
4546 @anchor{targetevents}
4547 @section Target Events
4548 @cindex target events
4549 @cindex events
4550 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4551 For example:
4552 @itemize @bullet
4553 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4554 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4555 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4556 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4557 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4558 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4559 to set up system clocks or
4560 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4561 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4562 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4563 @end itemize
4564
4565 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4566 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4567 @command{target create ... -event}.
4568
4569 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4570 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4571 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4572
4573 @example
4574 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4575 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4576 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4577 @}
4578 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4579 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4580 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4581 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4582 @}
4583 @end example
4584
4585 The following target events are defined:
4586
4587 @itemize @bullet
4588 @item @b{debug-halted}
4589 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4590 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4591 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4592 @item @b{early-halted}
4593 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4594 @item @b{examine-start}
4595 @* Before target examine is called.
4596 @item @b{examine-end}
4597 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4598 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4599 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4600 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4601 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4602 connect GDB to running target.
4603 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4604 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4605 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4606 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4607 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4608 is in RAM or read only memory.
4609 Default is @code{halt}
4610 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4611 @* When GDB disconnects
4612 @item @b{gdb-end}
4613 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4614 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4615 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4616 @code{reset init})
4617 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4618 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4619 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4620 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4621 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4622 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4623 @item @b{gdb-start}
4624 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4625 @item @b{halted}
4626 @* The target has halted
4627 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4628 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4629 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4630 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4631 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4632 @item @b{reset-assert}
4633 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4634 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4635 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4636 it instead of asserting SRST.
4637 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4638 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4639 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4640 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4641 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4642 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4643 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4644 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4645 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4646 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4647 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4648 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4649 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4650 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4651 released on the scan chain.
4652 @item @b{reset-end}
4653 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4654 @item @b{reset-init}
4655 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4656 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4657
4658 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4659 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4660 multiplexing, and so on.
4661 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4662 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4663 @item @b{reset-start}
4664 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4665 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4666
4667 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4668 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4669 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4670 @item @b{resume-start}
4671 @* Before any target is resumed
4672 @item @b{resume-end}
4673 @* After all targets have resumed
4674 @item @b{resumed}
4675 @* Target has resumed
4676 @item @b{trace-config}
4677 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4678 @end itemize
4679
4680 @node Flash Commands
4681 @chapter Flash Commands
4682
4683 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4684 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4685 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4686 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4687 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4688 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4689 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4690 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4691 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4692
4693 Flash Steps:
4694 @enumerate
4695 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4696 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4697 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4698 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4699 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4700 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4701 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4702 @item GDB Flashing
4703 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4704 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4705 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4706 @end enumerate
4707
4708 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4709 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4710 so that it can't boot.
4711 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4712 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4713
4714 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4715 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4716 @cindex flash configuration
4717
4718 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4719 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4720 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4721 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4722 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4723 see the driver-specific documentation.
4724
4725 @itemize @bullet
4726 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4727 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4728 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4729 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4730 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4731 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4732 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4733 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4734 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4735 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4736 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4737 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4738 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4739 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4740 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4741 commands to the flash controller.
4742 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4743 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4744 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4745 for more information.
4746 @end itemize
4747 @quotation Note
4748 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4749 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4750 @end quotation
4751 @end deffn
4752
4753 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4754 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4755 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4756 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4757 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4758 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4759 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4760 @end deffn
4761
4762 @deffn Command {flash list}
4763 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4764 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4765 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4766 @end deffn
4767
4768 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4769 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4770 depends on the flash type.
4771 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4772 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4773 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4774 but most don't bother.
4775 @end deffn
4776
4777 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4778 @cindex flash erasing
4779 @cindex flash reading
4780 @cindex flash writing
4781 @cindex flash programming
4782 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4783
4784 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4785 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4786 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4787 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4788 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4789
4790 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4791 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4792 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4793 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4794 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4795
4796 @quotation Note
4797 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4798 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4799 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4800 back to a flash bank.
4801 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4802 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4803 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4804 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4805 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4806 @end quotation
4807
4808 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4809 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4810 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4811 disabled first.
4812 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4813 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4814 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4815
4816 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4817 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4818 up to and including @var{last}.
4819 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4820 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4821 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4822 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4823 @end deffn
4824
4825 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4826 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4827 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4828 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4829 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4830 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4831 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4832 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4833 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4834 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4835 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4836 before erase starts.
4837 @end deffn
4838
4839 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4840 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4841 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4842 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4843 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4844 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4845 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4846 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4847 before issuing this command.
4848 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4849 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4850 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4851 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4852 @end deffn
4853 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4854
4855 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4856 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4857 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4858 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4859 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4860 @end deffn
4861
4862 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
4863 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4864 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
4865 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
4866 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
4867 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4868 @end deffn
4869
4870 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
4871 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4872 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
4873 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
4874 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4875 @end deffn
4876
4877 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4878 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4879 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4880 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4881 to the base address for each section in the image.
4882 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4883 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4884 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4885 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4886 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4887 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4888 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4889 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4890 each image section.
4891
4892 @quotation Warning
4893 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4894 data you want to preserve.
4895 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4896 sections might be erased with no notice.
4897 @itemize
4898 @item
4899 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4900 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4901 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4902 @item
4903 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4904 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4905 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4906 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4907 @end itemize
4908 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4909 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4910 @end quotation
4911
4912 @end deffn
4913
4914 @section Other Flash commands
4915 @cindex flash protection
4916
4917 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4918 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4919 and display that status.
4920 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4921 @end deffn
4922
4923 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4924 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4925 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4926
4927 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4928 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4929 and possibly stale information.
4930 @end deffn
4931
4932 @anchor{flashprotect}
4933 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4934 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
4935 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
4936 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4937 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
4938 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4939 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4940 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
4941 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
4942 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
4943 @end deffn
4944
4945 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4946 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4947 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4948 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4949 @end deffn
4950
4951 @anchor{program}
4952 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4953 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4954 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4955 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4956 @end deffn
4957
4958 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4959 @section Flash Driver List
4960 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4961 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4962 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4963
4964 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4965 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4966 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4967
4968 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4969
4970 @itemize
4971 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4972 @end itemize
4973
4974 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4975 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4976 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4977 @example
4978 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4979 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
4980 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4981 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
4982 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4983 @end example
4984 @end deffn
4985
4986 @subsection External Flash
4987
4988 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4989 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4990 @cindex CFI
4991 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4992 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4993 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4994 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4995 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4996 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4997 configure a bus and its timings), or
4998 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4999 on the flash chip.
5000 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5001 speed up operation.
5002
5003 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5004
5005 @itemize
5006 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5007 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5008 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5009 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5010 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5011 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
5012 @end itemize
5013
5014 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5015 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5016
5017 @example
5018 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5019 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5020 @end example
5021
5022 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5023 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5024 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5025
5026 @example
5027 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5028 @end example
5029
5030 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5031 @end deffn
5032
5033 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5034 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5035 @cindex SPI
5036 @cindex jtagspi
5037 @cindex bscan_spi
5038 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5039 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5040 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5041 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5042 accessed through JTAG.
5043
5044 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5045 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5046 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5047 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5048 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5049 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5050
5051 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5052 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5053 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5054 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5055 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5056 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5057 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5058 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5059
5060 @itemize
5061 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5062 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5063 @var{USER1} instruction.
5064 @end itemize
5065
5066 @example
5067 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5068 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5069 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5070 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5071 @end example
5072 @end deffn
5073
5074 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5075 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5076 @cindex xcf
5077 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5078 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5079 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5080 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5081 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5082
5083 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5084 command accepts additional parameters:
5085 @itemize
5086 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5087 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5088 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5089 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5090 in master mode.
5091 @end itemize
5092 @example
5093 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5094 @end example
5095 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5096 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5097 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5098 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5099 dedicated sector.
5100 @end deffn
5101
5102 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5103 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5104 button.
5105 @example
5106 xcf configure 0
5107 @end example
5108 @end deffn
5109
5110 Additional driver notes:
5111 @itemize
5112 @item Only single revision supported.
5113 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5114 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5115 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5116 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5117 @end itemize
5118 @end deffn
5119
5120 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5121 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5122 @cindex SPIFI
5123 @cindex lpcspifi
5124 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5125 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5126 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5127
5128 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5129 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5130 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5131 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5132 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5133
5134 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5135 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5136 are configured by the driver.
5137
5138 @example
5139 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5140 @end example
5141
5142 @end deffn
5143
5144 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5145 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5146 @cindex SMI
5147 @cindex stmsmi
5148 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5149 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5150 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5151 SPI flash devices.
5152 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5153 flash devices can be connected.
5154
5155 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5156 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5157 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5158 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5159 the flash content.
5160
5161 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5162 to identify the memory bank.
5163 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5164 flash size, are detected automatically.
5165
5166 @example
5167 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5168 @end example
5169
5170 @end deffn
5171
5172 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5173 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5174 Microcontroller platform.
5175
5176 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5177 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5178
5179 @example
5180 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5181 @end example
5182
5183 @end deffn
5184
5185 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5186 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5187 @cindex ath79
5188 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5189 chip selects.
5190 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5191 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5192 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5193 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5194 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5195 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5196
5197 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5198 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5199 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5200 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5201 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5202 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5203 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5204 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5205 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5206 with the default CS0.
5207 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5208 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5209 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5210
5211 @example
5212 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5213
5214 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5215 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5216 # banks.
5217 flash bank flash0 ath79 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5218 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5219 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5220 @end example
5221
5222 @end deffn
5223
5224 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5225
5226 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5227 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5228 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5229 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5230 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5231 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5232
5233 @example
5234 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5235 @end example
5236 @end deffn
5237
5238 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5239 @cindex ambiqmicro
5240 @cindex apollo
5241 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5242 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5243 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5244 with the target using SWD.
5245
5246 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5247 the device class of the MCU.
5248 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5249 to set up the flash banks.
5250 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5251 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5252
5253 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5254 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5255 and the second bank starts after the first.
5256
5257 @example
5258 # Flash bank 0
5259 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5260 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5261 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5262 $_TARGETNAME
5263 @end example
5264
5265 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5266 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5267 are available to the user.
5268
5269 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5270
5271 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5272 Erase entire bank.
5273 @end deffn
5274 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5275 Erase device pages.
5276 @end deffn
5277 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5278 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5279 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
5280 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
5281 the flash.
5282 @end deffn
5283 @end deffn
5284
5285 @anchor{at91samd}
5286 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5287 @cindex at91samd
5288 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5289 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5290 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5291
5292 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5293 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5294 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5295 processor to be halted.
5296 @end deffn
5297
5298 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5299 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5300 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5301 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5302 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5303 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5304
5305 @example
5306 at91samd set-security enable
5307 @end example
5308 @end deffn
5309
5310 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5311 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5312 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5313 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5314 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5315 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5316 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5317 in order to disable this feature.
5318
5319 @example
5320 at91samd eeprom
5321 at91samd eeprom 1024
5322 @end example
5323 @end deffn
5324
5325 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5326 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5327 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5328 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5329 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5330 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5331
5332 @example
5333 at91samd bootloader
5334 at91samd bootloader 16384
5335 @end example
5336 @end deffn
5337
5338 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5339 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5340 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5341 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5342 @end deffn
5343
5344 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5345 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5346 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5347 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5348 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5349 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5350 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5351 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5352
5353 @example
5354 # Read user row
5355 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5356 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5357 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5358 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5359 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5360 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5361 @end example
5362 @end deffn
5363
5364 @end deffn
5365
5366 @anchor{at91sam3}
5367 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5368 @cindex at91sam3
5369 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5370 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5371 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5372 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5373 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5374 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5375 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5376 chips are confirmed.}
5377
5378 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5379 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5380 the following fixed locations:
5381
5382 @example
5383 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5384 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5385 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5386 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5387 @end example
5388
5389 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5390 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5391 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5392
5393 @itemize
5394 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5395 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5396 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5397 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5398 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5399 @end itemize
5400
5401 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5402
5403 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5404 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5405 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5406 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5407 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5408 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5409 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5410
5411 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5412 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5413 @end deffn
5414
5415 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5416 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5417 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5418 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5419 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5420 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5421 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5422 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5423 @end deffn
5424
5425 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5426 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5427 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5428 @end deffn
5429 @end deffn
5430
5431 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5432 @cindex at91sam4
5433 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5434 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5435 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5436 @end deffn
5437
5438 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5439 @cindex at91sam4l
5440 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5441 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5442 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5443
5444 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5445 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5446 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5447 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5448 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5449 @end deffn
5450 @end deffn
5451
5452 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5453 @cindex atsamv
5454 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5455 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5456 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5457 @end deffn
5458
5459 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5460 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5461 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5462 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5463 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5464
5465 @example
5466 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5467 @end example
5468
5469 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5470 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5471
5472 @itemize
5473 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5474 @item @var{banks}
5475 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5476 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5477 @item @var{pages_size}
5478 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5479 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5480 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5481 @end itemize
5482
5483 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5484 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5485 will be autoconfigured.
5486 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5487
5488 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5489 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5490 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5491 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5492 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5493
5494 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5495 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5496 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5497 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5498 are not truly general purpose).
5499 @quotation Note
5500 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5501 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5502 @end quotation
5503 @end deffn
5504 @end deffn
5505
5506 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5507 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5508 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5509 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5510 @end deffn
5511
5512 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5513 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5514 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5515 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5516
5517 @example
5518 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5519 @end example
5520
5521 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5522 each single sector one by one.
5523
5524 @example
5525 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5526 @end example
5527
5528 @example
5529 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5530 @end example
5531
5532 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5533
5534 @end deffn
5535
5536 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5537 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5538 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5539 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5540 autoconfigures itself.
5541 @example
5542 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5543 @end example
5544 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5545 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5546 this via the following command:
5547 @example
5548 efm32 debuglock num
5549 @end example
5550 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5551 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5552 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5553 supported.}
5554 @end deffn
5555
5556 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5557 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5558 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5559 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5560 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5561 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5562 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5563
5564 @example
5565 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5566 @end example
5567 @end deffn
5568
5569 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5570 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5571 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5572 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5573 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5574 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5575 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5576 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5577 characters) ignored.
5578
5579 @example
5580 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5581 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5582 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5583 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5584 @end example
5585 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5586 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5587 @end deffn
5588
5589 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5590 @cindex kinetis
5591 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5592 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5593 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5594 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5595 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5596 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5597
5598 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5599 @itemize
5600 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5601 @end itemize
5602
5603 @example
5604 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5605 @end example
5606
5607 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5608 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5609 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5610 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5611 @end deffn
5612
5613 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5614 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5615 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5616 set by 'flash protect' command.
5617 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5618 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5619 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5620 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5621 with the rest of a flash image.
5622 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5623 @end deffn
5624
5625 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5626 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5627 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5628 @end deffn
5629
5630 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5631 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5632 @end deffn
5633
5634 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5635 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5636 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5640 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5641 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5642 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5643 command completes.
5644 @end deffn
5645
5646 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5647 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5648 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5649 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5650 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5651
5652 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5653 Program Partition command.
5654
5655 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5656 Reset the device after partition setting.
5657
5658 Show partition size:
5659 @example
5660 kinetis nvm_partition info
5661 @end example
5662
5663 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5664 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5665 @example
5666 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5667 @end example
5668
5669 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5670 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5671 @example
5672 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5673 @end example
5674 @end deffn
5675
5676 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5677 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5678 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5679 @end deffn
5680
5681 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5682 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5683 Command disables watchdog timer.
5684 @end deffn
5685 @end deffn
5686
5687 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5688 @cindex kinetis_ke
5689 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5690 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5691 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5692 autoconfigures itself.
5693 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5694
5695 @example
5696 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5697 @end example
5698
5699 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5700 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5701 @end deffn
5702
5703 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5704 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5705 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5706 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5707 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5708 @end deffn
5709
5710 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5711 Command disables watchdog timer.
5712 @end deffn
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5716 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5717 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5718 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5719 microcontroller families from NXP.
5720
5721 @quotation Note
5722 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5723 driver:
5724 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5725 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5726 @end quotation
5727
5728 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5729 which must appear in the following order:
5730
5731 @itemize
5732 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5733 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5734 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5735 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5736 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5737 LPC43x[2357])
5738 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5739 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5740 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5741 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5742 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5743 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5744 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5745 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5746 at which the core is running
5747 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5748 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5749 @quotation Note
5750 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5751 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5752 However, if you do provide it,
5753 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5754 @end quotation
5755 @end itemize
5756
5757 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5758
5759 @example
5760 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5761 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5762 @end example
5763
5764 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5765 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5766 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5767 @end deffn
5768 @end deffn
5769
5770 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5771 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5772 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5773 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5774 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5775 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5776
5777 @example
5778 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5779 @end example
5780 @end deffn
5781
5782 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5783 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5784 from NXP.
5785
5786 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5787 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5788 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5789 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5790 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5791 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5792 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5793 you start the PLL.
5794
5795 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5796
5797 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5798 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5799 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5800
5801 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5802 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5803 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5804 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5805 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5806 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5807 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5808
5809 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5810 @example
5811 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5812 @end example
5813
5814 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5815 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5816 @code{flash banks} command.
5817
5818 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5819 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5820 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5821 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5822 a known signature.
5823 Example:
5824 @example
5825 lpc2900 signature 0
5826 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5827 @end example
5828 @end deffn
5829
5830 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5831 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5832 saves it to a file in binary format.
5833 Example:
5834 @example
5835 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5836 @end example
5837 @end deffn
5838
5839 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5840 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5841 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5842 command:
5843
5844 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5845 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5846 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5847 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5848
5849 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5850 Example:
5851 @example
5852 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5853 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5854 @end example
5855 @end deffn
5856
5857 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5858 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5859 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5860 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5861 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5862 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5863 912 bytes.
5864 @quotation Attention
5865 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5866 @end quotation
5867 Example:
5868 @example
5869 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5870 @end example
5871 @end deffn
5872
5873 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5874 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5875 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5876 after the next power cycle.
5877 @quotation Attention
5878 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5879 @end quotation
5880 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5881 Example:
5882 @example
5883 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5884 flash info 0
5885 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5886 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5887 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5888 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5889 @end example
5890 @end deffn
5891
5892 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5893 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5894 effective after the next power cycle.
5895 @quotation Attention
5896 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5897 @end quotation
5898 Examples:
5899 @example
5900 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5901 @end example
5902 @end deffn
5903 @end deffn
5904
5905 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5906 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5907 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5908 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5909
5910 @example
5911 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5912 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5913 @end example
5914
5915 @itemize @bullet
5916 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5917 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5918 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5919 @end itemize
5920
5921 Example usage:
5922 @example
5923 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5924 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5925 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5926 @} else @{
5927 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5928 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5929 @}
5930 @end example
5931 @end deffn
5932
5933 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5934 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5935 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5936 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5937 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5938 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5939 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5940 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5941 also have division into regions: main and info.
5942 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5943 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5944
5945 @example
5946 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5947 @end example
5948
5949 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5950
5951 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5952 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5953 @end deffn
5954
5955 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5956 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5957 @end deffn
5958
5959 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5960 Erase all userflash including info region.
5961 @end deffn
5962
5963 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5964 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5965 @end deffn
5966
5967 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5968 Check sectors protect.
5969 @end deffn
5970
5971 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5972 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5973 @end deffn
5974
5975 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5976 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5980 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5981 @end deffn
5982
5983 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5984 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5985 @end deffn
5986
5987 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5988 Show information about flash driver.
5989 @end deffn
5990
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
5994 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5995 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5996 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
5997 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
5998
5999 @example
6000 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6001 @end example
6002
6003 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6004
6005 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6006 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6007 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6008 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6009 code.
6010 @end deffn
6011
6012 @end deffn
6013
6014 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6015 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6016 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6017
6018 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6019 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6020 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6021 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6022
6023 @example
6024 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6025 @end example
6026 @end deffn
6027
6028 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6029 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6030 and integrate flash memory.
6031
6032 @example
6033 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6034 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6035 @end example
6036
6037 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6038 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6039 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6040 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6041 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6042 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6043 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6044 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6045 @end deffn
6046 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6047 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6048 This will remove any Code Protection.
6049 @end deffn
6050 @end deffn
6051
6052 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6053 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6054 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6055 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6056 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6057
6058 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6059 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6060
6061 @example
6062 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6063 @end example
6064
6065 psoc4-specific commands
6066 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6067 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6068
6069 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6070 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6071
6072 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6073 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6074 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6075
6076 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6077 @end deffn
6078
6079 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6080 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6081
6082 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6083 @end deffn
6084 @end deffn
6085
6086 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6087 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6088 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6089 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6090
6091 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6092 @itemize @bullet
6093 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6094 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6095 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6096 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6097 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6098 row size: 512 bytes.
6099 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6100 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6101 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6102 operation will erase row automatically.
6103 @end itemize
6104
6105 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6106 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6107
6108 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6109
6110 @example
6111 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6112 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6113 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6114 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6115 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6116 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6117
6118 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6119 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6120 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6121 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6122 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6123 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6124 @end example
6125
6126 psoc6-specific commands
6127 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6128 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6129 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6130 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6131 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6132 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6133 @end deffn
6134
6135 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6136 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6137 by @command{flash banks}.
6138 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6139 @end deffn
6140 @end deffn
6141
6142 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6143 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6144 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6145 and SWD interface.
6146 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6147 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6148
6149 @example
6150 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6151 @end example
6152
6153 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6154
6155 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6156 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6157 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6158 @end deffn
6159
6160 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6161 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6162 @end deffn
6163 @end deffn
6164
6165 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6166 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6167 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6168 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6169 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6170
6171 @example
6172 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6173 @end example
6174
6175 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6176 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6177 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6178 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6179 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6180 disabled.
6181
6182 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6183 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6184 @quotation Warning
6185 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6186 applied to all of them.
6187 @end quotation
6188 @end deffn
6189 @end deffn
6190
6191 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6192 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6193 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6194 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6195 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6196
6197 @example
6198 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6199 @end example
6200
6201 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6202 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6203 the flash driver.
6204
6205 @example
6206 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6207 @end example
6208
6209 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6210 as per the following example.
6211 @example
6212 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6213 @end example
6214
6215 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6216
6217 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6218 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6219 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6220 @end deffn
6221
6222 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6223 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6224 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6225 @end deffn
6226
6227 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6228 Mass erases the entire stm32f1x device.
6229 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6230 @end deffn
6231
6232 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6233 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
6234 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
6235 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6236 @end deffn
6237
6238 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6239 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6240 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6241 @end deffn
6242 @end deffn
6243
6244 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6245 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6246 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6247 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6248 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6249
6250 @example
6251 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6252 @end example
6253
6254 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6255 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6256 the flash driver.
6257
6258 @example
6259 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6260 @end example
6261
6262 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6263
6264 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6265 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6266 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6267 @end deffn
6268
6269 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6270 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6271 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6272 @end deffn
6273
6274 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6275 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6276 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6277 @end deffn
6278
6279 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6280 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6281 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6282 @end deffn
6283
6284 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6285 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6286 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6287 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6288 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6289 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6290 @end deffn
6291
6292 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6293 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6294 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6295 @end deffn
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6299 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6300 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6301 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6302 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6303
6304 @example
6305 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6306 @end example
6307
6308 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6309 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6310 the flash driver.
6311
6312 @example
6313 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6314 @end example
6315
6316 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6317
6318 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6319 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6320 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6321 @end deffn
6322
6323 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6324 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6325 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6326 @end deffn
6327
6328 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6329 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6330 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6331 @end deffn
6332 @end deffn
6333
6334 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6335 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6336 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6337 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6338 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6339
6340 @example
6341 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6342 @end example
6343
6344 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6345 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6346 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6347 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6348 second bank.
6349
6350 @example
6351 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6352 @end example
6353
6354 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6355
6356 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6357 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6358 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6359 @end deffn
6360
6361 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6362 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6363 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6364 @end deffn
6365
6366 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6367 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6368 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6369 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6370 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6371 @end deffn
6372 @end deffn
6373
6374 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6375 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6376 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6377 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6378 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6379
6380 @example
6381 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6382 @end example
6383
6384 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6385 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6386 the flash driver.
6387
6388 @example
6389 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6390 @end example
6391
6392 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6393
6394 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6395 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6396 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6397 @end deffn
6398
6399 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6400 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6401 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6402 @end deffn
6403
6404 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6405 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6406 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6407 @end deffn
6408 @end deffn
6409
6410 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6411 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6412 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6413 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6414 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6415
6416 @example
6417 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6418 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6419 @end example
6420
6421 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6422 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6423 for the specified flash bank.
6424 @end deffn
6425 @end deffn
6426
6427 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6428 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6429 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6430 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6431 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6432
6433 @example
6434 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6435 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6436 @end example
6437
6438 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6439 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6440 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6441
6442 @itemize @bullet
6443 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6444 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6445 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6446 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6447 @end itemize
6448 @end deffn
6449
6450 @end deffn
6451
6452 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6453 @cindex str9xpec
6454
6455 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6456 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6457 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6458 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6459
6460 Here is some background info to help
6461 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6462 the str9:
6463 @enumerate
6464 @item
6465 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6466 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6467 @item
6468 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6469 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6470 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6471 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6472 @end enumerate
6473
6474 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6475 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6476 configured for flash bank 0.
6477 @example
6478 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6479 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6480 jtag_reset 0 1
6481 # turn off target polling
6482 poll off
6483 # disable str9 core
6484 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6485 # read option bytes
6486 str9xpec options_read 0
6487 # re-enable str9 core
6488 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6489 poll on
6490 reset halt
6491 @end example
6492 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6493 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6494 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6495 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6496
6497 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6498
6499 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6500 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6501 @end deffn
6502
6503 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6504 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6505 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6506 @end deffn
6507
6508 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6509 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6510 erase the device.
6511 @end deffn
6512
6513 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6514 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6515 @end deffn
6516
6517 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6518 Configure str9 boot bank.
6519 @end deffn
6520
6521 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6522 Configure str9 lvd source.
6523 @end deffn
6524
6525 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6526 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6530 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6531 @end deffn
6532
6533 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6534 Read str9 option bytes.
6535 @end deffn
6536
6537 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6538 Write str9 option bytes.
6539 @end deffn
6540
6541 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6542 unlock str9 device.
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6548 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6549 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6550 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6551
6552 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6553
6554 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6555 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6559 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6560 @end deffn
6561
6562 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6563 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6564 the flash clock.
6565 @end deffn
6566 @end deffn
6567
6568 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6569 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6570 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6571 @end deffn
6572
6573 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6574 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6575 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6576
6577 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6578
6579 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6580 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6584 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6585 @end deffn
6586
6587 @end deffn
6588
6589 @section NAND Flash Commands
6590 @cindex NAND
6591
6592 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6593 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6594 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6595
6596 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6597 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6598 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6599 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6600 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6601 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6602
6603 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6604 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6605 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6606 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6607 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6608 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6609 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6610 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6611 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6612 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6613
6614 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6615 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6616 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6617 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6618 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6619 every 512 bytes of data.
6620
6621 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6622 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6623 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6624 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6625 ECC mode is used.
6626
6627 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6628 @enumerate
6629 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6630 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6631 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6632 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6633 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6634 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6635 to access that device.
6636 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6637 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6638 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6639 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6640 de-brick a board.
6641 @end enumerate
6642
6643 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6644 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6645 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6646 are only 32 bits wide.
6647 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6648 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6649 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6650 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6651
6652 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6653 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6654 @cindex NAND configuration
6655
6656 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6657 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6658 OpenOCD has initialized.
6659
6660 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6661 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6662 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6663 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6664 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6665 they were a single (larger) device.
6666 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6667 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6668
6669 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6670 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6671 configuration files, not interactively.
6672
6673 @itemize @bullet
6674 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6675 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6676 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6677 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6678 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6679 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6680 commands to the NAND controller.
6681 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6682 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6683 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6684 for more information.
6685 @end itemize
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn Command {nand list}
6689 Prints a summary of each device declared
6690 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6691 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6692 @example
6693 > nand list
6694 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6695 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6696 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6697 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6698 >
6699 @end example
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6703 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6704 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6705 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6706 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6707 it with most other NAND commands.
6708 @end deffn
6709
6710 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6711
6712 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6713 @cindex NAND reading
6714 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6715 starting at the specified offset.
6716 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6717
6718 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6719 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6720
6721 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6722 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6723 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6724
6725 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6726 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6727 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6728 method which handled that error correction.
6729
6730 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6731 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6732 @itemize @bullet
6733 @item no oob_* parameter
6734 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6735 @item @code{oob_raw}
6736 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6737 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6738 spare areas associated with each data page.
6739 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6740 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6741 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6742 @item @code{oob_only}
6743 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6744 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6745 spare areas associated with each data page.
6746 @end itemize
6747 @end deffn
6748
6749 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6750 @cindex NAND erasing
6751 @cindex NAND programming
6752 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6753 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6754 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6755 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6756 If those parameters are not specified,
6757 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6758 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6759
6760 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6761 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6762 block marker.
6763 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6764 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6765 @end deffn
6766
6767 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6768 @cindex NAND writing
6769 @cindex NAND programming
6770 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6771 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6772 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6773 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6774
6775 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6776 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6777
6778 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6779 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6780 past the end of the device.
6781 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6782 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6783 if that's being written.)
6784
6785 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6786 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6787 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6788
6789 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6790 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6791 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6792 @itemize @bullet
6793 @item no oob_* parameter
6794 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6795 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6796 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6797 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6798 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6799 @item @code{oob_only}
6800 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6801 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6802 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6803 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6804 @item @code{oob_raw}
6805 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6806 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6807 un-altered OOB.
6808 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6809 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6810 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6811 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6812 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6813 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6814 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6815 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6816 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6817 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6818 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6819 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6820 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6821 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6822 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6823 @end itemize
6824 @end deffn
6825
6826 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6827 @cindex NAND verification
6828 @cindex NAND programming
6829 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6830 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6831 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6832
6833 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6834 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6835
6836 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6837 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6838 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6839 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6840 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6841
6842 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6843 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6844 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6845
6846 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6847 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6848 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6849 be removed in a future release.
6850 @end deffn
6851
6852 @subsection Other NAND commands
6853 @cindex NAND other commands
6854
6855 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6856 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6857 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6858 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6859 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6860 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6861 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6862 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6863
6864 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6865 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6866 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6867 @end deffn
6868
6869 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6870 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6871 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6872 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6873 status for each block.
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6877 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6878 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6879
6880 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6881 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6882 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6883 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6884 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6885
6886 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6887 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6888 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6889 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6890 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6891 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6892 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6893 @end deffn
6894
6895 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6896 @subsection NAND Driver List
6897 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6898 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6899 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6900
6901 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6902 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6903 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6904 address of the ECC controller.
6905 @example
6906 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6907 @end example
6908 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6909 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6910 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6911 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6912 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6913 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6914 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6915 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6916 @end deffn
6917 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6918 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6919 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6920 @end deffn
6921
6922 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6923 properly configured for input or output.
6924 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6925 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6926 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6927 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6928 @end deffn
6929 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6930 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6931 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6932 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6933 @end deffn
6934 @end deffn
6935
6936 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6937 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6938 chips from Texas Instruments.
6939 It takes three extra parameters:
6940 address of the NAND chip;
6941 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6942 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6943 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6944 @example
6945 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6946 @end example
6947 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6948 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6949 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6950 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6951 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6952 @end deffn
6953
6954 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6955 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6956 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6957 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6958 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6959 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6960 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6964 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6965 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6966 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6967 @end deffn
6968 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6969
6970 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6971 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6972 should work for this chip aswell.
6973 @end deffn
6974
6975 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6976 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6977 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6978 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6979 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6980 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6981 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6982 @example
6983 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6984 @end example
6985 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6986 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6987 without parameter query status.
6988 @end deffn
6989 @end deffn
6990
6991 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6992 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6993 parameter: the address of the controller.
6994 @example
6995 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6996 @end example
6997 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6998 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6999 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7000 change any behavior.
7001 @end deffn
7002
7003 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7004 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7005 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7006 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7007 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7008 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7009 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7010 specialized commands.
7011 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7012 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7013 change any behavior.
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @section mFlash
7017
7018 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7019 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7020
7021 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7022 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7023 address @var{base}.
7024 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7025 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7026
7027 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7028
7029 @example
7030 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7031 @end example
7032
7033 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7034
7035 @example
7036 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7037 @end example
7038 @end deffn
7039
7040 @subsection mFlash commands
7041 @cindex mFlash commands
7042
7043 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7044 Configure mflash PLL.
7045 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7046 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7047 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7048 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7049 @end deffn
7050
7051 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7052 Configure bootable option.
7053 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7054 (4kB) for boot.
7055 @end deffn
7056
7057 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7058 Configure storage information.
7059 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7060 written.
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7064 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7065 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7066 @end deffn
7067
7068 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7069 Probe mflash.
7070 @end deffn
7071
7072 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7073 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7074 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7075 @end deffn
7076
7077 @node Flash Programming
7078 @chapter Flash Programming
7079
7080 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7081 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7082 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7083
7084 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7085 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7086
7087 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
7088 @enumerate
7089 @item 'init' is executed.
7090 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7091 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7092 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7093 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7094 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7095 @end enumerate
7096
7097 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7098
7099 @example
7100 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7101 # are optional parameters
7102 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7103 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7104
7105 # binary files need the flash address passing
7106 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7107 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7108 @end example
7109
7110 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7111 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7112 @cindex PLD
7113 @cindex FPGA
7114
7115 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7116 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7117 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7118 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7119 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7120 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7121 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7122
7123 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7124
7125 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7126 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7127 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7128
7129 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7130 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7131
7132 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7133 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7134 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7135 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7136 behavior.
7137 @end deffn
7138
7139 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7140 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7141 @end deffn
7142
7143 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7144 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7145 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7146 @end deffn
7147
7148 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7149
7150 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7151 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7152 that particular type of PLD.
7153
7154 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7155 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7156 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7157
7158 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7159 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7160 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7161
7162 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7163 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7164 for FPGA @var{num}.
7165 @end deffn
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @node General Commands
7169 @chapter General Commands
7170 @cindex commands
7171
7172 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7173 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7174 commands are documented elsewhere.
7175
7176 Intent:
7177 @itemize @bullet
7178 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7179 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7180 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
7181 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7182
7183 @item @b{From the human}
7184 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7185 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7186
7187 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7188 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7189 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7190
7191 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7192 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7193 port is 5555.
7194 @end itemize
7195
7196
7197 @section Server Commands
7198
7199 @deffn {Command} exit
7200 Exits the current telnet session.
7201 @end deffn
7202
7203 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7204 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7205 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7206 Not every command provides helptext.
7207
7208 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7209 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7210 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7211 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7215 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7216 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7217 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7218 Useful in connection with script files
7219 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7220 @end deffn
7221
7222 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7223 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7224 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7225 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7226 @end deffn
7227
7228 @anchor{debuglevel}
7229 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7230 @cindex message level
7231 Display debug level.
7232 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7233 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7234 Level 0 is error messages only;
7235 level 1 adds warnings;
7236 level 2 adds informational messages;
7237 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7238 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7239 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7240 the command line along with the location of that log
7241 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7242 @xref{Running}.
7243 @end deffn
7244
7245 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7246 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7247 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7248 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7249 @example
7250 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7251 @end example
7252 @end deffn
7253
7254 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7255 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7256 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7257 @end deffn
7258
7259 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7260 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7261 @end deffn
7262
7263 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7264 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7265 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7266 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7267 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7271 @section Target State handling
7272 @cindex reset
7273 @cindex halt
7274 @cindex target initialization
7275
7276 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7277 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7278 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7279 a current target which is used to perform the
7280 various operations. The current target may be changed
7281 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7282 target which should become current.
7283
7284 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7285 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7286 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7287 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7288 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7289
7290 @emph{With no arguments}:
7291 list all available registers for the current target,
7292 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7293 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7294 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7295 are flagged as such.
7296
7297 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7298 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7299 bypassing any internal cache.
7300
7301 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7302 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7303 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7304 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7305 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7306 relevant module will flush such values.
7307
7308 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7309 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7310
7311 @example
7312 > reg
7313 ===== ARM registers
7314 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7315 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7316 (2) r2 (/32)
7317 ...
7318 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7319 >
7320 @end example
7321 @end deffn
7322
7323 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7324 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7325 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7326 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7327 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7328 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7329 (and enter debug mode).
7330 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7331
7332 @quotation Warning
7333 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7334 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7335 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7336 power mode by gating the core clock;
7337 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7338
7339 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7340 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7341 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7342 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7343 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7344 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7345
7346 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7347 work with a JTAG debugger.
7348 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
7349 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7350 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7351 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7352 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7353 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7354 @end quotation
7355
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @deffn Command resume [address]
7359 Resume the target at its current code position,
7360 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7361 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7362 @end deffn
7363
7364 @deffn Command step [address]
7365 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7366 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7367 @end deffn
7368
7369 @anchor{resetcommand}
7370 @deffn Command reset
7371 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7372 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7373 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7374 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7375 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7376 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7377
7378 The optional parameter specifies what should
7379 happen after the reset.
7380 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7381 The other options will not work on all systems.
7382 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7383
7384 @itemize @minus
7385 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7386 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7387 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7388 @end itemize
7389 @end deffn
7390
7391 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7392 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7393 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7394 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7395 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7396 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7397 state.
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 @section I/O Utilities
7401
7402 These commands are available when
7403 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7404 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7405 notably the ZY1000.
7406 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7407
7408 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7409
7410 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7411 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7412 the text file @file{filename}.
7413 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7414 The last string is followed by a newline.
7415 @end deffn
7416
7417 @deffn Command cat filename
7418 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7419 @end deffn
7420
7421 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7422 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7423 into @file{dest_filename}.
7424 @end deffn
7425
7426 @deffn Command ip
7427 @emph{No description provided.}
7428 @end deffn
7429
7430 @deffn Command ls
7431 @emph{No description provided.}
7432 @end deffn
7433
7434 @deffn Command mac
7435 @emph{No description provided.}
7436 @end deffn
7437
7438 @deffn Command meminfo
7439 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7440 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443 @deffn Command peek
7444 @emph{No description provided.}
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn Command poke
7448 @emph{No description provided.}
7449 @end deffn
7450
7451 @deffn Command rm filename
7452 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7453 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7454 @end deffn
7455
7456 @deffn Command trunc filename
7457 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7458 @end deffn
7459
7460 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7461 @section Memory access commands
7462 @cindex memory access
7463
7464 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7465 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7466 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7467 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7468
7469 @enumerate
7470 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7471 to change the current target.
7472 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7473 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7474 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7475 @end enumerate
7476
7477 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7478 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7479 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7480 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7481 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7482 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7483 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7484 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7485 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7486 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7487 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7488 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7489 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7490 @end deffn
7491
7492 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7493 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7494 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7495 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7496 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7497 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7498 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7499 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7500 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7501 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7502 @end deffn
7503
7504 @anchor{imageaccess}
7505 @section Image loading commands
7506 @cindex image loading
7507 @cindex image dumping
7508
7509 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7510 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7511 binary file named @var{filename}.
7512 @end deffn
7513
7514 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7515 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7516 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
7517 @end deffn
7518
7519 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7520 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7521 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7522 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7523 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7524 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7525 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7526 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7527 separately.
7528 @end deffn
7529
7530 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7531 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7532 The file format may optionally be specified
7533 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7534 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
7535 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7536 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7537 @example
7538 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7539 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7540 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7541 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7542 $address $length
7543 @}
7544 @end example
7545 @end deffn
7546
7547 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7548 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7549 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7550 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7551 The file format may optionally be specified
7552 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7553 @end deffn
7554
7555 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7556 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7557 The file format may optionally be specified
7558 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7559 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7563 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7564 The file format may optionally be specified
7565 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7566 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7567 @end deffn
7568
7569
7570 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7571 @cindex breakpoint
7572 @cindex watchpoint
7573
7574 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7575 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7576 watchpoints.
7577 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7578
7579 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7580 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7581 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7582 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7583 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7584 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7585
7586 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7587 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7588 @end deffn
7589
7590 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7591 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7592 @end deffn
7593
7594 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7595 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7596 @end deffn
7597
7598 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7599 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7600 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7601 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7602 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7603 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7604 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7605 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7606 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7607 @end deffn
7608
7609 @section Misc Commands
7610
7611 @cindex profiling
7612 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7613 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7614 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7615 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7616 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7617 limit the address range.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn Command {version}
7621 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7622 @end deffn
7623
7624 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7625 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7626 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7627 @end deffn
7628
7629 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7630 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7631 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7632 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7633
7634 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7635 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7636 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7637 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7638
7639 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7640 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7641 @cindex tracing
7642 @cindex ETM
7643 @cindex ETB
7644
7645 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7646 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7647 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7648
7649 @itemize
7650 @item
7651 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7652 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7653 supports such an interface.
7654 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7655 and trace port support.)
7656 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7657 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7658 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7659 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7660 in the board-specific configuration file.
7661 @item
7662 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7663 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7664 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7665 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7666 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7667 @end itemize
7668
7669 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7670
7671 @quotation Issues
7672 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7673 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7674
7675 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7676 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7677 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7678 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7679 dummy trace port driver}.
7680
7681 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7682 as well as tracing only during specific states
7683 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7684
7685 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7686 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7687 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7688 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7689 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7690
7691 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7692 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7693 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7694 this original style of JTAG access.
7695 @end quotation
7696
7697 @subsection ETM Configuration
7698 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7699
7700 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7701 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7702 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7703
7704 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7705 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7706 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7707 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7708 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7709 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7710 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7711 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7712 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7713
7714 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7715 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7716 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7717
7718 @quotation Warning
7719 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7720 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7721 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7722 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7723 @end quotation
7724
7725 @quotation Note
7726 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7727 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7728 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7729 what CPU activities are traced.
7730 @end quotation
7731 @end deffn
7732
7733 @deffn Command {etm info}
7734 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7735 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7736 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7737 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7738 @end deffn
7739
7740 @deffn Command {etm status}
7741 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7742 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7743 Did trace data overflow?
7744 Was it triggered?
7745 @end deffn
7746
7747 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7748 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7749 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7750 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7751 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7752
7753 @itemize
7754 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7755 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7756 The value is one of
7757 @option{none} (save nothing),
7758 @option{data} (save data),
7759 @option{address} (save addresses),
7760 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7761 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7762 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7763 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7764 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7765 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7766 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7767 trace stream without an image of the code.
7768 @end itemize
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7772 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7773 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7774 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7775 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7776
7777 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7778 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7779 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7780 @end deffn
7781
7782 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7783
7784 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7785 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7786 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7787
7788 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7789 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7790 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7791 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7792 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7793 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7794 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7795
7796 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7797
7798 @itemize
7799 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7800 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7801 for instruction access within that function's body.
7802 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7803 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7804 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7805 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7806 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7807 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7808 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7809 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7810 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7811 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7812 @item @emph{... more}
7813 @end itemize
7814
7815 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7816 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7817
7818 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7819 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7820 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7821 @end deffn
7822
7823 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7824 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7825 @end deffn
7826
7827 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7828 Opens an image file.
7829 @end deffn
7830
7831 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7832 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7833 @end deffn
7834
7835 @deffn Command {etm start}
7836 Starts trace data collection.
7837 @end deffn
7838
7839 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7840 Stops trace data collection.
7841 @end deffn
7842
7843 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7844 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7845
7846 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7847
7848 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7849 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7850 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7851 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7852 any trace data collection.}
7853 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7854 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7855 @end deffn
7856 @end deffn
7857
7858 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7859 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7860 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7861 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7862 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7863 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7864 @end deffn
7865 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7866 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7867 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7868 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7869 trace trigger becomes active.
7870
7871 @itemize
7872 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7873 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7874 afterwards.
7875 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7876 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7877 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7878 what caused that event to happen.
7879 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7880 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7881 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7882 how the event caused trouble.
7883 @end itemize
7884 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7885 @end deffn
7886
7887 @end deffn
7888
7889 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7890 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7891 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7892 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7893 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7894
7895 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7896 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7897
7898 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7899 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7900 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7901 @end deffn
7902
7903 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7904 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7908 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7909 @end deffn
7910 @end deffn
7911
7912 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
7913 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
7914 @cindex CTI
7915
7916 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
7917 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
7918 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
7919 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
7920 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
7921 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
7922
7923 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
7924 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
7925 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
7926 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
7927 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
7928 including additional configuration.
7929 @end deffn
7930
7931 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
7932 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
7933 @end deffn
7934
7935 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
7936 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
7937 @end deffn
7938
7939 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
7940 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
7941 @end deffn
7942
7943 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
7944 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
7945 @end deffn
7946
7947 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
7948 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
7949 of the CTI.
7950 @end deffn
7951
7952 @deffn Command {cti names}
7953 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
7954 useful in TCL scripting.
7955 @end deffn
7956
7957 @section Generic ARM
7958 @cindex ARM
7959
7960 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7961 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7962 commands that may be available.
7963
7964 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7965 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7966 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7967 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7968 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7969 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7970 @end deffn
7971
7972 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7973 @cindex disassemble
7974 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7975 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7976 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7977 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7978 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7979 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7980 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7981
7982 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7983 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7984 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7985 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7986 with a handful of exceptions.
7987 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7988 @end deffn
7989
7990 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7991 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7992 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7993 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7994 and using the MCR instruction.
7995 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7996 an ARM register.)
7997 @end deffn
7998
7999 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8000 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8001 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8002 and the MRC instruction.
8003 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8004 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8005 an ARM register.)
8006 @end deffn
8007
8008 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8009 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8010 core mode if necessary.
8011 @end deffn
8012
8013 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8014 @cindex ARM semihosting
8015 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8016
8017 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8018 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8019 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8020 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8021 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8022 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8023 @end deffn
8024
8025 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8026 @cindex ARM semihosting
8027 Set the command line to be passed to the debuggee.
8028
8029 @example
8030 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8031 @end example
8032
8033 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8034 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8035 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8036 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8037 @end deffn
8038
8039 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8040 @cindex ARM semihosting
8041 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8042 status.
8043
8044 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8045 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8046 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8047 debugger.
8048 @end deffn
8049
8050 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8051 @cindex ARMv4
8052 @cindex ARMv5
8053
8054 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8055 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8056 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8057 variant.
8058
8059 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8060 @cindex ARM7
8061 @cindex ARM9
8062
8063 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8064 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8065 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8066 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8067
8068 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8069 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8070 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8071 instead of breakpoints.
8072 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8073
8074 This should be
8075 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8076 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8077 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8078 @end deffn
8079
8080 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8081 @cindex DCC
8082 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8083 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8084 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8085
8086 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8087 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8088 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8092 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8093 that don't check completion of the operation.
8094 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8095
8096 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8097 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8098 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8099 @end deffn
8100
8101 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8102 @cindex ARM720T
8103
8104 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8105 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8106 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8107 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8108
8109 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8110 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8111 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8112
8113 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8114 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8115 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8116 @end deffn
8117
8118 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8119 @cindex ARM9
8120
8121 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8122 integer processors.
8123 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8124
8125 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8126 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8127 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8128 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8129
8130 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8131 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8132 @cindex vector_catch
8133 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8134 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8135 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8136 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8137 to those hardware vectors.
8138
8139 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8140 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8141 vector catch hardware to intercept
8142 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8143 @option{none} of them,
8144 or a list with one or more of the following:
8145 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8146 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8147 @end deffn
8148
8149 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8150 @cindex ARM920T
8151
8152 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8153 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8154 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8155 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8156 and ARM9 commands.
8157
8158 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8159 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8160 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8161 @end deffn
8162
8163 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8164 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8165 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8166 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8167 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8168 (Not all registers can be written.)
8169 @end deffn
8170
8171 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8172 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8173 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8174
8175 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8176 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8177 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8178 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8179 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8180 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8181 @end deffn
8182
8183 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8184 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8188 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8189 @end deffn
8190
8191 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8192 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8193
8194 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8195 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8196 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8197 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8198 and ARM9 commands.
8199
8200 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8201 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8202
8203 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8204 Print information about the caches found.
8205 @end deffn
8206
8207 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8208 @cindex ARM966E
8209
8210 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8211 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8212 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8213 and ARM9 commands.
8214
8215 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8216 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8217 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8218 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8219 ARM966E-S TRM.
8220 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8221 as required for BIST support.
8222 @end deffn
8223
8224 @subsection XScale specific commands
8225 @cindex XScale
8226
8227 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8228
8229 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8230 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8231 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8232 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8233 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8234 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8235 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8236
8237 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8238 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
8239 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8240 the mini-IC.
8241
8242 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8243 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8244 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8245 code layout in memory:
8246 @example
8247 _vectors:
8248 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8249 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8250 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8251 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8252 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8253 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8254 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8255 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8256 .org 0x100
8257 .long real_reset_vector
8258 .long real_ui_handler
8259 .long real_swi_handler
8260 .long real_pf_abort
8261 .long real_data_abort
8262 .long 0 /* unused */
8263 .long real_irq_handler
8264 .long real_fiq_handler
8265 @end example
8266
8267 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8268 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8269 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8270 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8271 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8272 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8273 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8274 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8275 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8276 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8277 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8278 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8279 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8280 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8281 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8282 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8283 software.
8284
8285 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8286 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8287 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8288 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8289
8290 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8291 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8292 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8293 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8294 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8295 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8296 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8297 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8298 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8299
8300 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8301 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8302
8303 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8304 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8305 @end deffn
8306
8307 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8308 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8309 @end deffn
8310
8311 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8312 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8313 @end deffn
8314
8315 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8316 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8317 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8318 @end deffn
8319
8320 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8321 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8322 @end deffn
8323
8324 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8325 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8326 @end deffn
8327
8328 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8329 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8330 @end deffn
8331
8332 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8333 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8334 @end deffn
8335
8336 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8337 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8338 @end deffn
8339
8340 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8341 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8342 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8343 and modifying how it is emptied.
8344 @end deffn
8345
8346 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8347 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8348 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8349 The image @var{type} may be one of
8350 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8351 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8352 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8353 @end deffn
8354
8355 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8356 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8357 @cindex vector_catch
8358 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8359 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8360
8361 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8362 @example
8363 0x01 Trap Reset
8364 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8365 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8366 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8367 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8368 0x20 reserved
8369 0x40 Trap IRQ
8370 0x80 Trap FIQ
8371 @end example
8372 @end deffn
8373
8374 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8375 @cindex vector_table
8376
8377 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8378 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8379 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8380 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8381 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8382
8383 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8384
8385 @end deffn
8386
8387 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8388 @cindex ARMv6
8389
8390 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8391 @cindex ARM11
8392
8393 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8394 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8395 which is enabled by default.
8396 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8397 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8398 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8399 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8400 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8401 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8402 @end deffn
8403
8404 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8405 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8406 which is enabled by default.
8407 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8408 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8412 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8413 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8414 they are disabled by default.
8415 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8416 @end deffn
8417
8418 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8419 @cindex vector_catch
8420 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8421 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8422 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8423
8424 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8425 for certain hardware events.
8426 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8427 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8428 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8429 @end deffn
8430
8431 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8432 @cindex ARMv7
8433 @cindex ARMv8
8434
8435 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8436 @cindex Cortex-A
8437
8438 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8439 display information about target caches
8440 @end deffn
8441
8442 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8443 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8444 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8445 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8446 Defaults to 'off'.
8447 @end deffn
8448
8449 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8450 Initialize core debug
8451 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8452 @end deffn
8453
8454 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8455 Disable SMP mode
8456 @end deffn
8457
8458 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8459 Enable SMP mode
8460 @end deffn
8461
8462 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8463 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8464 @end deffn
8465
8466 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8467 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8471 configure l2x cache
8472 @end deffn
8473
8474
8475 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8476 @cindex Cortex-R
8477
8478 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8479 Initialize core debug
8480 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8481 @end deffn
8482
8483 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8484 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8485 @end deffn
8486
8487
8488 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8489 @cindex tracing
8490 @cindex SWO
8491 @cindex SWV
8492 @cindex TPIU
8493 @cindex ITM
8494 @cindex ETM
8495
8496 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8497 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8498 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8499
8500 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8501 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8502 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8503 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8504
8505 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8506 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8507 debugger adapter features.
8508
8509 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8510 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8511
8512 Command options:
8513 @itemize @minus
8514 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8515 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8516 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8517 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8518 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8519 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8520 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8521 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8522 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8523 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8524 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8525 coding;
8526 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8527 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8528 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8529 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8530 data is to be output via SWO;
8531 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8532 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8533 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8534 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8535 rate automatically.
8536 @end itemize
8537
8538 Example usage:
8539 @enumerate
8540 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8541 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8542 enough to:
8543 @example
8544 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8545 ...
8546 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8547 ...
8548 @end example
8549 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8550 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8551 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8552 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8553 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8554 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8555 @example
8556 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8557 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8558 @end example
8559 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8560 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8561 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8562 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8563 @example
8564 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8565 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8566 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8567 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8568 @end example
8569 @end enumerate
8570 @end deffn
8571
8572 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8573 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8574 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8575 @end deffn
8576
8577 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8578 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8579 @end deffn
8580
8581 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8582 @cindex Cortex-M
8583
8584 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8585 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8586
8587 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8588 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8589 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8590 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8591 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8592 the step command leaves with the core running.
8593
8594 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8595 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8596 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8597
8598 Default is @option{auto}.
8599 @end deffn
8600
8601 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8602 @cindex vector_catch
8603 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8604 for certain hardware events.
8605
8606 Parameters request interception of
8607 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8608 @option{none} of them,
8609 or one or more of the following:
8610 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8611 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8612 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8613 @option{irq_err},
8614 @option{state_err},
8615 @option{chk_err}, or
8616 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8617 @option{reset}.
8618 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8619 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8620 are mapped to HardFault.
8621 UsageFault checks for
8622 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8623 must also be explicitly enabled.
8624
8625 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8626 @end deffn
8627
8628 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8629 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8630 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8631 @itemize @minus
8632 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8633 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8634 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8635 @end itemize
8636 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8637 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8638 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8639 the peripherals.
8640 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8641 @end deffn
8642
8643 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
8644 @cindex ARMv8-A
8645 @cindex aarch64
8646
8647 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
8648 Display information about target caches
8649 @end deffn
8650
8651 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
8652 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
8653 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
8654 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
8655 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
8656 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
8657 @end deffn
8658
8659 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
8660 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
8661 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
8662 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
8663 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8667 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
8668 @option{on}.
8669 @end deffn
8670
8671 @section Intel Architecture
8672
8673 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8674 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8675 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8676 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8677 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8678 @itemize
8679 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8680 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8681 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8682 @end itemize
8683
8684 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8685 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8686 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8687
8688 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8689 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8690 @end deffn
8691
8692 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8693 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8694 @end deffn
8695
8696 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8697 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8698 @end deffn
8699
8700 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8701 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8702 @end deffn
8703
8704 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8705 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8706 @end deffn
8707
8708 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8709 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8710 @end deffn
8711
8712 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8713
8714 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8715 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8716
8717 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8718 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8719 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8720 @end deffn
8721 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8722 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8723
8724 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8725
8726 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8727 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8728 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8729 @end deffn
8730
8731 @subsection Registers commands
8732 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8733 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8734 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8735
8736 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8737
8738 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8739 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8740 and "timer" groups.
8741
8742 @emph{example:}
8743 @example
8744 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8745 @end example
8746
8747
8748 @end deffn
8749 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8750 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8751
8752 @emph{group} can be "system",
8753 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8754 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8755 @end deffn
8756
8757 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8758 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8759 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8760 @cindex tracing
8761 @cindex libdcc
8762 @cindex DCC
8763 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8764 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8765 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8766 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8767
8768 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8769 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8770 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8771 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8772 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8773 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8774
8775 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8776 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8777 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8778 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8779 The target being debugged may
8780 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8781 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8782 each supported by a command:
8783
8784 @itemize
8785 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8786 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8787 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8788 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8789
8790 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8791 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8792 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8793
8794 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8795 and then displayed at any time.
8796 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8797
8798 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8799 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8800 @end itemize
8801
8802 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8803 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8804 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8805 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8806 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8807 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8808 does the same thing.
8809
8810 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8811 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8812 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8813 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8814 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8815
8816 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8817 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8818 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8819 @end deffn
8820
8821 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8822 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8823 in the order they triggered.
8824 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8825 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8826 history records.
8827 @end deffn
8828
8829 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8830 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8831 they have been triggered.
8832 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8833 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8834 and associates it with that identifier.
8835
8836 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8837 are not related except by this command.
8838 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8839 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8840 @end deffn
8841
8842
8843 @node JTAG Commands
8844 @chapter JTAG Commands
8845 @cindex JTAG Commands
8846 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8847 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8848 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8849 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8850 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8851
8852 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8853 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8854
8855 @itemize @bullet
8856 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8857 devices such as a CPUs.
8858 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8859 standard state machine (in parallel)
8860 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8861 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8862 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8863 while the reading previous ones.
8864 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8865 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8866 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8867 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8868 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8869 registers.
8870 @end itemize
8871
8872 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8873
8874 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8875 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8876 the order of TAP state transitions.
8877 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8878 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8879 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8880 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8881 these commands are not available.
8882
8883 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8884 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8885 that specify the entire register.
8886 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8887 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8888 The return value holds the original value of each
8889 of those fields.
8890
8891 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8892 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8893 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8894 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8895 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8896
8897 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8898 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8899
8900 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8901 in that state.
8902 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8903 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8904 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8905
8906 @quotation Warning
8907 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8908 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8909 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8910 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8911 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8912 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8913 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8914 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8915 @end quotation
8916 @end deffn
8917
8918 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8919 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8920 This may be used for performance tuning.
8921
8922 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8923 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8924 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8925 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8926 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8927 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8928 @end deffn
8929
8930 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8931 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8932 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8933 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8934 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8935 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8936
8937 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8938 in that state.
8939 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8940 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8941 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8942
8943 @quotation Note
8944 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8945 register values, unlike data register values.
8946 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8947 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8948 @end quotation
8949 @end deffn
8950
8951 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8952 Set values of reset signals.
8953 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8954 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8955 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8956 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8957 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8958 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8959 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8960
8961 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8962 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8963 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8964 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8965 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8966 instead of the TRST signal.
8967 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8968 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8969 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8970 with handlers for that event.
8971 @end deffn
8972
8973 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8974 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8975 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8976 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8977 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8978 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8979 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8980 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8981 The final state must also be stable.
8982 @end deffn
8983
8984 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8985 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8986 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8987 Instructions often need some time
8988 to execute before they take effect.
8989 @end deffn
8990
8991 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8992 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8993
8994 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8995 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8996 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8997 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8998 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9002 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9003 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9004 must also be enabled.
9005 Default is enabled.
9006 @end deffn
9007
9008 @section TAP state names
9009 @cindex TAP state names
9010
9011 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9012 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9013 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9014 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9015
9016 @itemize @bullet
9017 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9018 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9019 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9020 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9021 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9022 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9023 through the data register
9024 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9025 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9026 for update or more shifting
9027 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9028 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9029 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9030 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9031 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9032 through the instruction register
9033 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9034 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9035 for update or more shifting
9036 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9037 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9038 @end itemize
9039
9040 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9041 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9042 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9043 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9044
9045 @itemize @bullet
9046 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9047 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9048 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9049 may not be as expected.
9050 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9051 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9052 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9053 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9054 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9055 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9056 @end itemize
9057
9058 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9059 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9060
9061 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9062 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9063 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9064 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9065
9066 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9067 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9068 @cindex SVF
9069
9070 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9071 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9072 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9073 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9074
9075 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9076 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9077 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9078 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9079
9080 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9081 affect their semantics.
9082
9083 Command options:
9084 @itemize @minus
9085 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9086 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9087 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9088 chain configuration, targetting @var{tapname};
9089 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9090 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9091 on the real interface;
9092 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9093 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9094 errors.
9095 @end itemize
9096 @end deffn
9097
9098 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9099 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9100 @cindex XSVF
9101
9102 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9103 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9104 Xilinx devices.
9105 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9106 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9107
9108 @quotation Important
9109 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9110 @end quotation
9111
9112 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9113 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9114 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9115 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9116 that TAP.
9117 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9118 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9119 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9120 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9121 @end deffn
9122
9123 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9124 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9125 after building the software.
9126 You may find them useful:
9127
9128 @itemize
9129 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9130 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9131 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9132 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9133 @end itemize
9134
9135 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9136 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9137 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9138 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9139 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9140 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9141 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9142
9143
9144 @node Utility Commands
9145 @chapter Utility Commands
9146 @cindex Utility Commands
9147
9148 @section RAM testing
9149 @cindex RAM testing
9150
9151 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9152 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9153 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9154 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9155 hardware problems.
9156
9157 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9158 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9159 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9160 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9161
9162 Load the memory testing functions with
9163
9164 @example
9165 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9166 @end example
9167
9168 to get access to the following facilities:
9169
9170 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9171 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9172 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9173 @end deffn
9174
9175 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9176 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9177 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9178 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9179 @end deffn
9180
9181 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9182 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9183 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9184 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9185 @end deffn
9186
9187 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9188 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9189 @end deffn
9190
9191 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9192 @cindex Firmware recovery
9193
9194 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9195 devices recovery with JTAG.
9196
9197 For quickstart instructions run:
9198 @example
9199 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9200 @end example
9201
9202 @node TFTP
9203 @chapter TFTP
9204 @cindex TFTP
9205 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9206 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9207
9208 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9209 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9210 server (tftpd). For example,
9211
9212 @example
9213 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9214 @end example
9215
9216 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9217 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9218
9219 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9220 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9221 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9222 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9223
9224 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9225 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9226 @cindex GDB
9227 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9228 to debug remote targets.
9229 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9230
9231 @itemize
9232 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9233 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9234 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9235 as shown in this chapter.
9236 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9237 that also will probably need to be configured.
9238 @end itemize
9239
9240 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9241 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9242 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9243 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9244 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9245 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9246
9247 @section Connecting to GDB
9248 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9249 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9250 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9251 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9252 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9253
9254 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9255
9256 @enumerate
9257 @item
9258 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9259 @example
9260 target remote localhost:3333
9261 @end example
9262 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9263
9264 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9265 @example
9266 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9267 @end example
9268 @item
9269 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9270 @example
9271 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9272 @end example
9273 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9274 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9275 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9276 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9277 @end enumerate
9278
9279 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9280 GDB command line.
9281
9282 @section Sample GDB session startup
9283
9284 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9285 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9286 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9287 small ARM program.
9288 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9289 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9290
9291 @example
9292 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9293 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9294 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9295 ...
9296 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9297 ...
9298 (gdb) load
9299 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9300 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9301 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9302 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9303 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9304 (gdb) continue
9305 Continuing.
9306 ...
9307 @end example
9308
9309 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9310 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9311 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9312 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9313
9314 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9315
9316 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9317 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9318 packet size and the device's memory map.
9319 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9320 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9321 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9322
9323 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9324 You may need to set those up by hand.
9325 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9326 something like:
9327
9328 @example
9329 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9330 @end example
9331
9332 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9333
9334 @example
9335 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9336 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9337 @end example
9338
9339 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9340 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9341 do not have such restrictions.
9342
9343 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9344 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9345 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9346 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9347
9348 @section Programming using GDB
9349 @cindex Programming using GDB
9350 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
9351
9352 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
9353 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
9354 @example
9355 gdb_memory_map disable
9356 @end example
9357 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
9358 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
9359 working area.
9360
9361 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
9362 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
9363 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
9364 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
9365
9366 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
9367 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
9368
9369 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
9370 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
9371 @example
9372 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
9373 @end example
9374
9375 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
9376 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
9377
9378 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
9379 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
9380 will be used.
9381
9382 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
9383 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
9384 @example
9385 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
9386 @end example
9387 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
9388
9389 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
9390 can be used.
9391
9392 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9393 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9394 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
9395
9396 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
9397 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
9398 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
9399
9400 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
9401 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
9402 and GDB treats it as it were running.
9403 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
9404 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
9405 without any intrusion of the target process.
9406
9407 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9408 Place following command after target configuration:
9409 @example
9410 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
9411 @end example
9412
9413 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
9414 switch off gdb_memory_map:
9415 @example
9416 gdb_memory_map disable
9417 @end example
9418
9419 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
9420 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
9421 @example
9422 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
9423 @end example
9424
9425 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
9426 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
9427
9428 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
9429 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
9430 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
9431 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
9432
9433 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
9434 previously shown varibles.
9435
9436 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
9437 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
9438 @cindex SMP
9439 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
9440 @itemize @bullet
9441 @item j - smp status request
9442 @item J - smp set request
9443 @end itemize
9444
9445 OpenOCD implements :
9446 @itemize @bullet
9447 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
9448 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
9449 @option{E01} for target not smp.
9450 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
9451 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
9452 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
9453 @end itemize
9454
9455 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
9456 @itemize @bullet
9457 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
9458 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
9459 @example
9460 set $_core 1
9461 #Jc01 packet is sent
9462 print $_core
9463 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
9464 @end example
9465
9466 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
9467 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
9468
9469 @example
9470 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
9471 define toggle0
9472 maint packet Jc0
9473 continue
9474 main packet Jc-1
9475 end
9476 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
9477 define toggle1
9478 maint packet Jc1
9479 continue
9480 main packet Jc-1
9481 end
9482 @end example
9483 @end itemize
9484
9485 @section RTOS Support
9486 @cindex RTOS Support
9487 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
9488
9489 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
9490 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
9491
9492 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
9493 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
9494 GDB commands.
9495
9496 @* An example setup is below:
9497
9498 @example
9499 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
9500 @end example
9501
9502 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
9503
9504 Currently supported rtos's include:
9505 @itemize @bullet
9506 @item @option{eCos}
9507 @item @option{ThreadX}
9508 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
9509 @item @option{linux}
9510 @item @option{ChibiOS}
9511 @item @option{embKernel}
9512 @item @option{mqx}
9513 @item @option{uCOS-III}
9514 @end itemize
9515
9516 @quotation Note
9517 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
9518 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
9519 @end quotation
9520
9521 @table @code
9522 @item eCos symbols
9523 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
9524 @item ThreadX symbols
9525 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
9526 @item FreeRTOS symbols
9527 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
9528 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
9529 @tex
9530 \begingroup
9531 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
9532 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
9533 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
9534 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
9535 \par
9536 \endgroup
9537 @end tex
9538 @item linux symbols
9539 init_task.
9540 @item ChibiOS symbols
9541 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
9542 @item embKernel symbols
9543 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
9544 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
9545 @item mqx symbols
9546 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
9547 @item uC/OS-III symbols
9548 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
9549 @end table
9550
9551 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
9552 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
9553
9554 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
9555 along with the project:
9556
9557 @table @code
9558 @item FreeRTOS
9559 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
9560 @item uC/OS-III
9561 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
9562 @end table
9563
9564 @node Tcl Scripting API
9565 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
9566 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
9567 @cindex Tcl scripts
9568 @section API rules
9569
9570 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
9571 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
9572 of state information as an argument to each proc.
9573
9574 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
9575 pair list and lists.
9576
9577 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
9578 list.
9579
9580 @example
9581 > set foo(me) Duane
9582 > set foo(you) Oyvind
9583 > set foo(mouse) Micky
9584 > set foo(duck) Donald
9585 @end example
9586
9587 If one does this:
9588
9589 @example
9590 > set foo
9591 @end example
9592
9593 The result is:
9594
9595 @example
9596 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
9597 @end example
9598
9599 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
9600
9601 @verbatim
9602 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
9603 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
9604 }
9605 @end verbatim
9606
9607 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
9608 should be passed in to the proc in question.
9609
9610 @section Internal low-level Commands
9611
9612 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
9613 invoke directly.
9614
9615 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
9616 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
9617 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
9618
9619 @itemize @bullet
9620 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9621
9622 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
9623 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
9624
9625 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
9626 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
9627
9628 Return information about the flash banks
9629
9630 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
9631
9632 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
9633 its execution. Example:
9634
9635 @example
9636 > capture "reset init"
9637 @end example
9638
9639 @end itemize
9640
9641 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
9642 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
9643 called "flash_banks".
9644
9645 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9646
9647 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9648 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9649 holds one of the following values:
9650
9651 @itemize @bullet
9652 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9653 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9654 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9655 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9656 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9657 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9658 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9659 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9660 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9661 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9662 @end itemize
9663
9664 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9665
9666 @quotation Note
9667 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9668 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9669 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9670 is jim, not real tcl).
9671 @end quotation
9672
9673 @section Tcl RPC server
9674 @cindex RPC
9675
9676 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9677 commands and receive the results.
9678
9679 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9680 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9681 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9682 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9683 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9684
9685 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9686 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9687 @command{capture} command.
9688
9689 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9690
9691 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9692 @cindex RPC Notifications
9693
9694 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9695 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9696
9697 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9698 in the following format.
9699
9700 @verbatim
9701 type target_event event [event-name]
9702 type target_state state [state-name]
9703 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9704 @end verbatim
9705
9706 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9707 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9708 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9709 Defaults to off.
9710
9711 @end deffn
9712
9713 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9714 @cindex RPC trace output
9715
9716 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9717 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9718
9719 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9720
9721 @verbatim
9722 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9723 @end verbatim
9724
9725 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9726 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9727 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9728 Defaults to off.
9729
9730 See an example application here:
9731 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9732
9733 @end deffn
9734
9735 @node FAQ
9736 @chapter FAQ
9737 @cindex faq
9738 @enumerate
9739 @anchor{faqrtck}
9740 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9741 @cindex RTCK
9742 @cindex adaptive clocking
9743 @*
9744
9745 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9746 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9747 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9748 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9749
9750 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9751 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9752 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9753 @enumerate
9754 @item
9755 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9756 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9757 @item
9758 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9759 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9760 @end enumerate
9761
9762 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9763 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9764 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9765 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9766 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9767 power).
9768
9769 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9770 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9771 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9772 ARM926 scenario).
9773 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9774 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9775 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9776
9777 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9778 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9779 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9780 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9781
9782 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9783
9784 In order to make use of this,
9785 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9786 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9787
9788 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9789 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9790 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9791 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9792 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9793
9794 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9795 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9796 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9797 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9798
9799 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9800 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9801 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9802 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9803 with a CPLD.
9804 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9805 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9806 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9807 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9808 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9809 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9810
9811 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9812
9813 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9814
9815 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9816 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9817 depending on the chips on your board.
9818 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9819 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9820 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9821
9822 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9823 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9824 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9825
9826 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9827 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9828 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9829 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9830
9831 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9832 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9833 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9834 this way.
9835
9836 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9837 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9838 clock rate.
9839 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9840 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9841 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9842
9843 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9844
9845 @example
9846 # Example: 1.234MHz
9847 adapter_khz 1234
9848 @end example
9849
9850
9851 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9852
9853 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9854 around Windows filenames.
9855
9856 @example
9857 > echo \a
9858
9859 > echo @{\a@}
9860 \a
9861 > echo "\a"
9862
9863 >
9864 @end example
9865
9866
9867 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9868
9869 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9870 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9871 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9872
9873 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9874 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9875 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9876
9877 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9878 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9879 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9880
9881 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9882
9883 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9884 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9885 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9886 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9887
9888 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9889 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9890 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9891
9892 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9893 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9894
9895 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9896 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9897 memory read caused data abort".
9898
9899 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9900 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9901 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9902 be done, feel free to add this here.
9903
9904 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9905 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9906 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9907 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9908 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9909 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9910 gracefully stops.
9911
9912 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9913 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9914 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9915
9916 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9917 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9918 bytes. Painful...
9919
9920
9921 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9922 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9923
9924 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9925 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9926 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9927 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9928 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9929 reset, everything else should work fine.
9930
9931 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9932 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9933 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9934 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9935
9936 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9937 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9938 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9939 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9940
9941 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9942
9943 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9944 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9945 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9946
9947 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9948 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9949
9950 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9951 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9952 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9953 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9954 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9955 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9956 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9957 clock frequency?
9958
9959 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9960 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9961 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9962 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9963 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9964
9965 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9966
9967 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9968 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9969 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9970 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9971 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9972 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9973 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9974
9975 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9976
9977 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9978 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9979 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9980 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9981
9982 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9983 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9984 particular order?
9985
9986 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9987 the same order used by the hardware.
9988
9989 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9990 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9991 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9992 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9993 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9994 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9995
9996 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9997 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9998 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9999 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10000
10001 @itemize @bullet
10002 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10003 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10004 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10005 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10006 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10007 @end itemize
10008
10009 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10010
10011 @itemize @bullet
10012 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10013 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10014 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10015 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10016 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10017 @end itemize
10018
10019
10020 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10021 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10022 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10023
10024 TODO.
10025
10026 @end enumerate
10027
10028 @node Tcl Crash Course
10029 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10030 @cindex Tcl
10031
10032 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10033 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10034 how the Tcl scripts work.
10035
10036 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10037 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10038 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10039 OpenOCD.
10040
10041 @section Tcl Rule #1
10042 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10043 @enumerate
10044 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10045 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10046 @end enumerate
10047
10048 The Tcl equal is this:
10049
10050 @enumerate
10051 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10052 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10053 @end enumerate
10054
10055 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10056 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10057
10058 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10059 There is a second pair of rules.
10060 @enumerate
10061 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10062 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10063 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10064 in Tcl.
10065 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10066 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10067 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10068 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10069 @end enumerate
10070
10071 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10072 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10073 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10074 Everything is a string}
10075
10076 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10077 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10078 difference is subtle.
10079 @enumerate
10080 @item Parse Time
10081 @item Evaluation Time
10082 @end enumerate
10083
10084 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10085 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10086 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10087
10088 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10089 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10090 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
10091 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10092
10093 @itemize @bullet
10094 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10095 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10096 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10097 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10098 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10099 @example
10100 # bash example
10101 X=`date`
10102 echo "The Date is: $X"
10103 # Tcl example
10104 set X [date]
10105 puts "The Date is: $X"
10106 @end example
10107 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10108 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10109 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10110 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10111 is a string}
10112 @example
10113 set x "Dinner"
10114 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10115 @end example
10116 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10117 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10118 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10119 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10120 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10121 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10122 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10123 @end itemize
10124
10125 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10126
10127 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10128
10129 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10130
10131 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10132 the normal way.
10133
10134 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10135 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10136 line is immedatly executed.
10137
10138 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10139 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10140
10141 @subsection Command Execution
10142
10143 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10144 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10145 control flow operators.
10146
10147 Commands are executed like this:
10148
10149 @enumerate
10150 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10151 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10152 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10153 @end enumerate
10154
10155 It sort of works like this:
10156 @example
10157 for(;;)@{
10158 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10159
10160 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10161
10162 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10163 @}
10164 @end example
10165
10166 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10167 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10168 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10169 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10170 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10171 ``LookupCommand()''
10172
10173 @subsection The FOR command
10174
10175 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10176 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10177 command just like any other command.
10178
10179 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10180 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10181 are:
10182
10183 @enumerate 0
10184 @item The ascii text 'for'
10185 @item The start text
10186 @item The test expression
10187 @item The next text
10188 @item The body text
10189 @end enumerate
10190
10191 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10192 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10193 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10194 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10195
10196 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10197 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10198
10199 @example
10200 int
10201 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10202 int *argc,
10203 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10204 @end example
10205
10206 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10207 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
10208 still operates in the same basic way.
10209
10210 @subsection FOR command implementation
10211
10212 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10213 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10214
10215 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10216
10217 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10218
10219 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10220 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10221 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10222
10223 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10224 expression and returns a value.
10225
10226 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10227 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10228 @example
10229 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10230
10231 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10232
10233 int
10234 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10235 int argc,
10236 char **argv )
10237 @{
10238 if( argc != 5 )@{
10239 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10240 return ERROR;
10241 @}
10242
10243 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10244
10245 // Execute the start statement.
10246 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10247
10248 // Top of loop test
10249 for(;;)@{
10250 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10251 if( i == 0 )
10252 break;
10253
10254 // Execute the body
10255 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10256
10257 // Execute the LOOP part
10258 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10259 @}
10260
10261 // Return no error
10262 SetResult( interp, "" );
10263 return SUCCESS;
10264 @}
10265 @end example
10266
10267 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10268 in the same basic way.
10269
10270 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10271
10272 @subsection source and find commands
10273 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10274 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10275 @*Remember the parsing rules
10276 @enumerate
10277 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10278 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10279 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10280 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10281 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10282 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10283 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10284 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10285 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10286 @end enumerate
10287 @subsection format command
10288 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10289 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10290 @b{sprintf()}.
10291 @b{Example}
10292 @example
10293 set x 6
10294 set y 7
10295 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10296 @end example
10297 @enumerate
10298 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10299 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10300 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10301 @* Refer to Rule #1
10302 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10303 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10304 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10305 @end enumerate
10306 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10307 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10308 @example
10309 #1 Good
10310 proc someproc @{@} @{
10311 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10312 @}
10313 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10314 #2 Good - no variables
10315 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
10316 #3 Good Curly Braces
10317 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10318 puts "Time: [date]"
10319 @}
10320 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10321 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10322 @end example
10323 @enumerate
10324 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10325 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10326 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10327 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10328 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10329 command.
10330 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10331 @*There are 4 examples:
10332 @enumerate
10333 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10334 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
10335 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
10336 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
10337 @end enumerate
10338
10339 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
10340 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
10341 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10342
10343 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10344 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10345 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
10346 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
10347 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
10348 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
10349 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
10350 @end enumerate
10351 @subsection Global Variables
10352 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
10353 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
10354 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
10355 @example
10356 proc myproc @{ @} @{
10357 set y 0 #Local variable Y
10358 global x #Global variable X
10359 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
10360 @}
10361 @end example
10362 @section Other Tcl Hacks
10363 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
10364 @example
10365 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
10366 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
10367 # Create var name
10368 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
10369 # Make it a global
10370 global $vn
10371 # Set it.
10372 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
10373 @}
10374 @end example
10375 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
10376 @example
10377 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
10378 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
10379 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
10380 @}
10381 @end example
10382
10383 @include fdl.texi
10384
10385 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
10386 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
10387 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
10388 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
10389 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
10390 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
10391
10392 @printindex cp
10393
10394 @node Command and Driver Index
10395 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
10396 @printindex fn
10397
10398 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)